HOLTEK HT56R25

HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
TinyPowerTM A/D Type 8-Bit OTP MCU with DAC
Technical Document
· Application Note
- HA0075E MCU Reset and Oscillator Circuits Application Note
Features
CPU Features
Peripheral Features
· Operating voltage:
· OTP Program Memory: 2K´14 ~ 32K´16
fSYS= 32768Hz: 2.2V~5.5V
fSYS= 4MHz: 2.2V~5.5V
fSYS= 8MHz: 3.0V~5.5V
fSYS= 12MHz: 4.5V~5.5V
· RAM Data Memory: 128´8 ~ 2304´8 Bits
· Watchdog Timer function
· Up to 50 bidirectional I/O lines
· 8 channel 12-bit ADC
· Up to 0.33ms instruction cycle with 12MHz system
· Up to 4 channel 12-bit PWM
· Software controlled 4-SCOM lines LCD driver with
clock at VDD= 5V
· Idle/Sleep mode and wake-up functions to reduce
1/2 bias
power consumption
· Multiple pin-shared external interrupts
· Up to three 8-bit programmable Timer/Event Counter
· Oscillator types:
External 32768Hz Crystal -- LXT
External RC -- ERC
Internal 4/8/12MHz RC -- HIRC
External high frequency crystal -- HXT
Internal 32kHz RC -- LIRC
with overflow interrupt and prescaler
· Up to one 16-bit programmable Timer/Event Counter
with overflow interrupt
· Serial Interfaces Module - SIM for SPI or I2C
· Time-Base functions
· Four operational modes: Normal, Slow, Idle, Sleep
· Low voltage reset function
· Low voltage detect function
· Fully integrated internal 4MHz, 8MHz and 12MHz os-
cillator requires no external components
· PFD/Buzzer for audio frequency generation
· All instructions executed in one or two instruction
· 12-bit Audio DAC output
cycles
· Wide range of available package types
· Table read instructions
· 63 powerful instructions
· Up to 12-level subroutine nesting
· Bit manipulation instruction
General Description
These TinyPowerTM A/D Type 8-bit high performance
RISC architecture microcontrollers are specifically, designed for applications that interface directly to analog signals. The devices include an integrated multi-channel
Analog to Digital Converter, Pulse Width Modulation and
and DAC outputs.
dustrial application areas. Some of these products
could include electronic metering, environmental monitoring, handheld instruments, electronically controlled
tools, motor driving in addition to many others.
The unique Holtek TinyPower technology also gives the
devices extremely low current consumption characteristics, an extremely important consideration in the present
trend for low power battery powered applications. The
usual Holtek MCU features such as power down and
wake-up functions, oscillator options, programmable
frequency divider, etc. combine to ensure user applications require a minimum of external components.
With their fully integrated SPI and I2C functions, designers are provided with a means of easy communication
with external peripheral hardware. The benefits of integrated A/D, PWM and DAC functions, in addition to low
power consumption, high performance, I/O flexibility
and low-cost, provides the device with the versatility for
a wide range of products in the home appliance and in-
Rev. 1.00
1
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
Selection Table
Part No.
Program
Data
Memory Memory
I/O
Timer
Time HIRC
8-bit 16-bit Base (MHz)
RTC
(LXT)
LCD
SCOM
A/D
D/A
PWM
Stack
Package
HT56R22
2K´14
128´8
22
2
¾
1
4/8/12
Ö
4
12-bit´8
12-bit´1
12-bit´3
6
16DIP/NSOP/SSOP
20DIP/SOP/SSOP
24SKDIP/SOP/SSOP
HT56R23
4K´15
256´8
42
2
1
1
4/8/12
Ö
4
12-bit´8
12-bit´1
12-bit´4
12
28SKDIP/SOP/SSOP
44QFP
HT56R24
8K´16
640´8
42
2
1
1
4/8/12
Ö
4
12-bit´8
12-bit´1
12-bit´4
12
28SKDIP/SOP/SSOP
44QFP
HT56R25
16K´16
1152´8
50
3
1
1
4/8/12
Ö
4
12-bit´8
12-bit´1
12-bit´4
12
28SKDIP/SOP
28SSOP(209mil)
44/52QFP
HT56R26
32K´16
2304´8
50
3
1
1
4/8/12
Ö
4
12-bit´8
12-bit´1
12-bit´4
12
28SKDIP/SOP
28SSOP(209ml)
44/52QFP
Note:
1. The devices are only available in OTP versions.
2. For devices that exist in more than one package formats, the table reflects the situation for the larger
package.
Block Diagram
The following block diagram illustrates the main functional blocks.
T im in g
G e r n e r a tio n
L C D
S C O M
P W M
D r iv e r
P F D
D r iv e r
I/O
P o rts
8 - b it
R IS C
M C U
C o re
D /A
C o n v e rte r
Rev. 1.00
A /D
C o n v e rte r
T im e
B a s e
T im e r
2
R O M /R A M
M e m o ry
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
Pin Assignment
P A 0 /A N 0
1
2 0
P A 1 /A N 1
V S S
2
1 9
P A 2 /A N 2
P A 0 /A N 0
1
1 6
P A 1 /A N 1
P C 3 /X T 2
3
1 8
P A 3 /A N 3 /P F D
V S S
2
1 5
P A 2 /A N 2
P C 2 /X T 1
4
1 7
P A 4 /A N 4 /IN T 0
P C 3 /X T 2
3
1 4
P A 3 /A N 3 /P F D
P C 1 /O S C 2
5
1 6
P A 5 /A N 5 /T C 0
P C 2 /X T 1
4
1 3
P A 4 /A N 4 /IN T 0
P C 0 /O S C 1
6
1 5
P A 6 /A N 6 /IN T 1
P C 1 /O S C 2
5
1 2
P A 5 /A N 5 /T C 0
V D D
7
1 4
P A 7 /A N 7 /T C 1
P C 0 /O S C 1
6
1 1
P A 6 /A N 6 /IN T 1
P C 7 /R E S
8
1 3
P D 1 /P W M 1 /S D O
V D D
7
1 0
P A 7 /A N 7 /T C 1
P B 4 /B Z
9
1 2
P D 0 /P W M 0 /S D I/S D A
P C 7 /R E S
8
9
1 0
1 1
P B 0 /S C K /S C L /C O M 0
P B 1 /S C S /C O M 1
P D 0 /P W M 0
H T 5 6 R 2 2
2 0 D IP -A /S O P -A /S S O P -A
H T 5 6 R 2 2
1 6 D IP -A /N S O P -A
P A 0 /A N 0
1
2 8
P A 1 /A N 1
V S S
2
2 7
P A 2 /A N 2
P A 0 /A N 0
1
2 4
P A 1 /A N 1
P C 3 /X T 2
3
2 6
P A 3 /A N 3 /P F D
V S S
2
2 3
P A 2 /A N 2
P C 2 /X T 1
4
2 5
P A 4 /A N 4 /IN T 0 /V D D IO
P C 3 /X T 2
3
2 2
P A 3 /A N 3 /P F D
P C 1 /O S C 2
5
2 4
P A 5 /A N 5 /T C 0 /S D O 1
P C 2 /X T 1
4
2 1
P A 4 /A N 4 /IN T 0 /V D D IO
P C 0 /O S C 1
6
2 3
P A 6 /A N 6 /IN T 1 /S D I1
P C 1 /O S C 2
5
2 0
P A 5 /A N 5 /T C 0 /S D O 1
V D D
7
2 2
P A 7 /A N 7 /T C 1 /S C K 1
P C 0 /O S C 1
6
1 9
P A 6 /A N 6 /IN T 1 /S D I1
P C 7 /R E S
8
2 1
P E 0 /[P F D ]/S C S 1
V D D
7
1 8
P A 7 /A N 7 /T C 1 /S C K 1
P C 6 /A U D
9
2 0
P D 3 /P W M 3
P C 7 /R E S
8
1 7
P D 2 /P W M 2 /S C S 1
P B 6 /T C 2
1 0
1 9
P D 2 /P W M 2
P B 5 /B Z /A U D
9
1 6
P D 1 /P W M 1 /S D O
P B 5 /B Z
1 1
1 8
P D 1 /P W M 1 /S D O
P B 4 /B Z
1 0
1 5
P D 0 /P W M 0 /S D I/S D A
P B 4 /B Z
1 2
1 7
P D 0 /P W M 0 /S D I/S D A
P B 3 /P IN T /C O M 3
1 1
1 4
P B 0 /S C K /S C L /C O M 0
P B 3 /P IN T /C O M 3
1 3
1 6
P B 0 /S C K /S C L /C O M 0
P B 2 /P C L K /C O M 2
1 2
1 3
P B 1 /S C S /C O M 1
P B 2 /P C L K /C O M 2
1 4
1 5
P B 1 /S C S /C O M 1
H T 5 6 R 2 3 /H T 5 6 R 2 4
2 8 S K D IP -A /S O P -A /S S O P -A
H T 5 6 R 2 2
2 4 S K D IP -A /S O P -A /S S O P -A
P D 5 /[P W M 1 ]
P D 6 /[T C 1 ]
P D 7 /[IN T 1 ]
P E 5 /[P W M 2 ]
P E 4
P E 3
C 0 ]
T 0 ]
S 1
K 1
D I1
P E 2 /[T
P E 1 /[IN
P E 0 /[P F D ]/S C
P A 7 /A N 7 /T C 1 /S C
P A 6 /A N 6 /IN T 1 /S
P A 5 /A N 5 /T C
P A 4 /A N 4 /IN T 0
P A 3 /A
P
P
P
0 /S D
/V D D
N 3 /P
A 2 /A
A 1 /A
A 0 /A
P
P
P
P
V
O 1
IO
F D
N 2
N 1
N 0
F 3
F 2
F 1
F 0
S S
4 4 4 3 4 2 4 1 4 0 3 9 3 8 3 7 3 6 3 5 3 4
1
3 3
2
3 2
3
3 1
4
3 0
5
2 9
H T 5 6 R 2 3 /H T 5 6 R 2 4
4 4 Q F P -A
6
7
2 8
2 7
8
2 6
9
2 5
1 0
1 1
2 4
1 2 1 3 1 4 1 5 1 6 1 7 1 8 1 9 2 0 2 1 2 2
2 3
P D 4
P D 3
P D 2
P D 1
P D 0
P B 0
P B 1
P B 2
P B 3
P B 4
P B 5
/[P
/P
/P
/P
/P
/S
/S
/P
/P
/B
/B
W M 0 ]
W M 3
W M 2
W M 1 /S D O
W M 0 /S D I/S D A
C K /S C L /C O M 0
C S /C O M 1
C L K /C O M 2
IN T /C O M 3
Z
Z
P B 6
P B 7
P C 4
P C 5
P C 6
P C 7
V D D
P C 0
P C 1
P C 2
P C 3
/T C 2
1
2
/A U D
/R E S
/O S
/O S
/X T
/X T
C 1
C 2
Note: Bracketed pin names indicate non-default pinout remapping locations.
Rev. 1.00
3
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
2 8
P A 1 /A N 1
2
2 7
P A 2 /A N 2
P C 3 /X T 2
3
2 6
P A 3 /A N 3 /P F D
P C 2 /X T 1
4
2 5
P A 4 /A N 4 /IN T 0 /V D D IO
P C 1 /O S C 2
5
2 4
P A 5 /A N 5 /T C 0 /S D O 1
P C 0 /O S C 1
6
2 3
P A 6 /A N 6 /IN T 1 /S D I1
V D D
7
2 2
P A 7 /A N 7 /T C 1 /S C K 1
P C 7 /R E S
8
2 1
P E 0 /[P F D ]/S C S 1
P C 6 /A U D
9
2 0
P D 3 /P W M 3
P B 6 /T C 2
1 0
1 9
P D 2 /P W M 2
P B 5 /B Z
1 1
1 8
P D 1 /P W M 1 /S D O
P B 4 /B Z
1 2
1 7
P D 0 /P W M 0 /S D I/S D A
P B 3 /P IN T B /C O M 3
1 3
1 6
P B 0 /S C K /S C L /C O M 0
P B 2 /P C L K /C O M 2
1 5
1 4
P D 5 /[P W M 1 ]
P D 6 /[T C 1 ]
P D 7 /[IN T 1 ]
P E 5 /[P W M 2 ]
P E 4
P E 3
C 0 ]
T 0 ]
S 1
K 1
D I1
1
V S S
P E 2 /[T
P E 1 /[IN
P E 0 /[P F D ]/S C
P A 7 /A N 7 /T C 1 /S C
P A 6 /A N 6 /IN T 1 /S
P A 0 /A N 0
P A 5 /A N 5 /T C
P A 4 /A N 4 /IN T 0
P A 3 /A
P
P
P
P B 1 /S C S /C O M 1
O 1
IO
F D
N 2
N 1
N 0
F 3
F 2
F 1
F 0
S S
4 4 4 3 4 2 4 1 4 0 3 9 3 8 3 7 3 6 3 5 3 4
1
3 3
2
3 2
3
3 1
4
3 0
5
2 9
H T 5 6 R 2 5 /H T 5 6 R 2 6
4 4 Q F P -A
6
7
2 8
2 7
8
2 6
9
2 5
1 0
1 1
2 4
1 2 1 3 1 4 1 5 1 6 1 7 1 8 1 9 2 0 2 1 2 2
2 3
P D 4
P D 3
P D 2
P D 1
P D 0
P B 0
P B 1
P B 2
P B 3
P B 4
P B 5
/[P
/P
/P
/P
/P
/S
/S
/P
/P
/B
/B
Z
W M 0 ]
W M 3
W M 2
W M 1 /S D O
W M 0 /S D I/S D A
C K /S C L /C O M 0
C S /C O M 1
C L K /C O M 2
IN T /C O M 3
Z
P B 6
P B 7
P C 4
P C 5
P C 6
P C 7
V D D
P C 0
P C 1
P C 2
P C 3
H T 5 6 R 2 5 /H T 5 6 R 2 6
2 8 S K D IP -A /S O P -A /S S O P -A (2 0 9 m il)
0 /S D
/V D D
N 3 /P
A 2 /A
A 1 /A
A 0 /A
P
P
P
P
V
/T C 2
/T C 3
1
2
/A U D
/R E S
/O S
/O S
/X T
/X T
C 1
C 2
P D 3 /P W M 3
P D 4 /[P W M 0 ]
P D 5 /[P W M 1 ]
P D 6 /[T C 1 [
P D 7 /[IN T 1 ]
P E 7
P E 6
P E 5 /[P W M 2 ]
P E 4
P E 3
P E 2 /[T C 0 ]
P E 1 /[IN T 0 ]
P E 0 /[P F D ]/S C S 1
P A 7
P A 6
P A 5
P A 4 /A
/A
/A
/A
N
N 7 /T C
N 6 /IN
N 5 /T C
4 /IN T 0
P A 3 /A
P
P
P
1 /S C K 1
T 1 /S D I1
0 /S D O 1
/V D D IO
N 3 /P F D
A 2 /A N 2
A 1 /A N 1
A 0 /A N 0
P F 3
P F 2
P F 1
P F 0
V S S
5 2 5 1 5 0 4 9 4 8 4 7 4 6 4 5 4 4 4 3 4 2 4 1 4 0
1
3 9
3 8
2
3 7
3
3 6
4
5
3 5
6
H T 5 6 R 2 5 /H T 5 6 R 2 6
5 2 Q F P -A
7
8
9
1 0
1 1
1 2
1 3
1 4 1 5 1 6 1 7 1 8 1 9 2 0 2 1 2 2 2 3 2 4 2 5 2 6
3 4
3 3
3 2
3 1
3 0
2 9
2 8
2 7
P D 2
P D 1
P D 0
P B 0
P B 1
P B 2
P B 3
P B 4
P B 5
P B 6
P B 7
P F 4
P F 5
/P W
/P W
/P W
/S C
/S C
/P C
/P IN
/B Z
/B Z
/T C
/T C
M 2
M 1 /S D O
M 0 /S D I/S D A
K /S C L /C O M 0
S /C O M 1
L K /C O M 2
T /C O M 3
2
3
P F 6
P F 7
P G 0
P G 1
P C 4
P C 5
P C 6
P C 7
V D D
P C 0
P C 1
P C 2
P C 3
1
2
/A U D
/R E S
/O S
/O S
/X T
/X T
C 1
C 2
Note: Bracketed pin names indicate non-default pinout remapping locations.
Rev. 1.00
4
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
Pin Description
HT56R22
Pin Name
Function
OPT
I/T
O/T
Description
PA0
PAPU
PAWK
ST
CMOS
General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up and wake-up.
AN0
ADCR
AN
¾
PA1
PAPU
PAWK
ST
CMOS
AN1
ADCR
AN
¾
PA2
PAPU
PAWK
ST
CMOS
AN2
ADCR
AN
¾
PA3
PAPU
PAWK
ST
CMOS
ST
¾
PFD output
A/D channel 3
PA0/AN0
PA1/AN1
PA2/AN2
PA3/PFD/AN3
PA4/INT0/AN4/VDDIO
PFD
CO
PINMAP
A/D channel 0
General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up and wake-up.
A/D channel 1
General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up and wake-up.
A/D channel 2
General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up and wake-up.
AN3
ADCR
AN
¾
PA4
PAPU
PAWK
ST
CMOS
INT0
PINMAP
ST
¾
External interrupt 0 input
AN4
ADCR
AN
¾
A/D channel 4
VDDIO
CO
PWR
¾
VDDIO power input
PA5
PAPU
PAWK
ST
CMOS
TC0
PINMAP
ST
¾
SDO1
CO
SPICTL0
¾
CMOS
AN5
ADCR
AN
¾
PA6
PAPU
PAWK
ST
CMOS
INT1
PINMAP
ST
¾
SDI1
CO
SPICTL0
¾
CMOS
AN6
ADCR
AN
¾
PA7
PAWK
ST
CMOS
TC1
PINMAP
ST
¾
SCK1
CO
SPICTL0
ST
CMOS
AN7
ADCR
AN
¾
PB0
PBPU
ST
CMOS
General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up.
SCK0
CO
SIMCTL0
ST
CMOS
SPI1 serial clock input or output
SCL
CO
SIMCTL0
ST
¾
SCOM0
SCOMC
¾
SCOM
General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up and wake-up.
General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up and wake-up.
External Timer 0 clock input
PA5/TC0/SDO1/AN5
SPI1 serial data output
A/D channel 5
General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up and wake-up.
External interrupt 1 input
PA6/INT1/SDI1/AN6
PA7/TC1/SCK1/AN7
SPI1 serial data input
A/D channel 6
General purpose I/O. Register enabled wake-up.
External Timer 1 clock input
SPI1 serial clock input or output
A/D channel 7
PB0/SCK0/SCL/SCOM0
Rev. 1.00
5
2
I C serial clock input
Software controlled 1/2 bias LCD COM
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
Pin Name
PB1/SCS0/SCOM1
PB2/PCLK/SCOM2
PB3/PINT/SCOM3
Function
OPT
I/T
O/T
PB1
PBPU
ST
CMOS
General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up.
SCS0
CO
SIMCTL0
ST
CMOS
SPI0 select control pin
SCOM1
SCOMC
¾
SCOM
Software controlled 1/2 bias LCD COM
PB2
PBPU
ST
CMOS
General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up.
PCLK
CO
SIMCTL0
¾
CMOS
Peripheral clock output
SCOM2
SCOMC
¾
SCOM
Software controlled 1/2 bias LCD COM
PB3
PBPU
ST
CMOS
General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up.
PINT
¾
ST
¾
SCOM3
SCOMC
¾
SCOM
PB4
PBPU
ST
CMOS
BZ
CO
¾
¾
PB5
PBPU
ST
CMOS
BZ
CO
¾
¾
Buzzer bar output
AUD
CO
DACTRL
AO
Audio output
PC0
PCPU
ST
OSC1
CO
AN
¾
PC1
PCPU
ST
CMOS
General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up.
OSC2
CO
¾
CMOS
Oscillator pin
PC2
PCPU
ST
CMOS
General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up.
PB4/BZ
PB5/BZ/AUD
PC0/OSC1
PC1/OSC2
PC2/XT1
CMOS
Description
Peripheral interrupt input, falling edge trigger
Software controlled 1/2 bias LCD COM
General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up.
Buzzer output
General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up.
General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up.
Oscillator pin
XT1
CO
¾
CMOS
Oscillator pin
PC3
PCPU
ST
CMOS
General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up.
XT2
CO
¾
LXT
PC7
PCPU
ST
NMOS
PC3/XT2
PC7/RES
Oscillator pin
General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up.
RES
CO
ST
¾
PD0
PDPU
ST
CMOS
General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up.
PWM0
PINMAP
¾
CMOS
PWM0 output
SDI0
CO
SIMCTL0
ST
¾
SDA
CO
SIMCTL0
ST
OD
PD1
PDPU
ST
CMOS
General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up.
PWM1
PINMAP
¾
CMOS
PWM1 output
SDO0
CO
SIMCTL0
¾
CMOS
SPI0 serial data output
PD2
PDPU
ST
CMOS
General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up.
PWM2
PINMAP
¾
CMOS
PWM2 output
SCS1
CO
SPICTL0
ST
CMOS
SPI1 chip select pin
VDD
VDD
¾
PWR
¾
Power supply
VSS
VSS
¾
PWR
¾
Ground
PD0/PWM0/SDI0/SDA
PD1/PWM1/SDO0
PD2/PWM2/SCS1
Rev. 1.00
6
Reset input
SPI0 serial data input
2
I C data input or output
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
Note:
I/T: Input type; O/T: Output type
OPT: Optional by configuration option (CO) or register option
PWR: Power; CO: Configuration option
ST: Schmitt Trigger input; CMOS: CMOS output; AN: analog input
SCOM= software controlled LCD COM
HXT: High frequency crystal oscillator
LXT: Low frequency crystal oscillator
HT56R23/HT56R24
Pin Name
Function
OPT
I/T
O/T
Description
PA0
PAPU
PAWK
ST
CMOS
General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up and wake-up.
AN0
ADCR
AN
¾
PA1
PAPU
PAWK
ST
CMOS
AN1
ADCR
AN
¾
PA2
PAPU
PAWK
ST
CMOS
AN2
ADCR
AN
¾
PA3
PAPU
PAWK
ST
CMOS
ST
¾
PFD output
A/D channel 3
PA0/AN0
PA1/AN1
PA2/AN2
PA3/PFD/AN3
PA4/INT0/AN4/VDDIO
PFD
CO
PINMAP
General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up and wake-up.
A/D channel 1
General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up and wake-up.
A/D channel 2
General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up and wake-up.
AN3
ADCR
AN
¾
PA4
PAPU
PAWK
ST
CMOS
INT0
PINMAP
ST
¾
External interrupt 0 input
AN4
ADCR
AN
¾
A/D channel 4
VDDIO
CO
PWR
¾
VDDIO power input
PA5
PAPU
PAWK
ST
CMOS
TC0
PINMAP
ST
¾
SDO1
CO
SPICTL0
¾
CMOS
AN5
ADCR
AN
¾
PA6
PAPU
PAWK
ST
CMOS
INT1
PINMAP
ST
¾
SDI1
CO
SPICTL0
¾
CMOS
AN6
ADCR
AN
¾
PA7
PAWK
ST
CMOS
TC1
PINMAP
ST
¾
SCK1
CO
SPICTL0
ST
CMOS
AN7
ADCR
AN
¾
PA5/TC0/SDO1/AN5
PA6/INT1/SDI1/AN6
PA7/TC1/SCK1/AN7
Rev. 1.00
A/D channel 0
7
General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up and wake-up.
General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up and wake-up.
External Timer 0 clock input
SPI1 serial data output
A/D channel 5
General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up and wake-up.
External interrupt 1 input
SPI1 serial data input
A/D channel 6
General purpose I/O. Register enabled wake-up.
External Timer 1 clock input
SPI1 serial clock input or output
A/D channel 7
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
Pin Name
Function
OPT
I/T
O/T
Description
PB0
PBPU
ST
CMOS
General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up.
SCK0
CO
SIMCTL0
ST
CMOS
SPI1 serial clock input or output
SCL
CO
SIMCTL0
ST
¾
SCOM0
SCOMC
¾
SCOM
Software controlled 1/2 bias LCD COM
PB1
PBPU
ST
CMOS
General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up.
SCS0
CO
SIMCTL0
ST
CMOS
SPI0 select control pin
SCOM1
SCOMC
¾
SCOM
Software controlled 1/2 bias LCD COM
PB2
PBPU
ST
CMOS
General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up.
PCLK
CO
SIMCTL0
¾
CMOS
Peripheral clock output
SCOM2
SCOMC
¾
SCOM
Software controlled 1/2 bias LCD COM
PB0/SCK0/SCL/SCOM0
PB1/SCS0/SCOM1
PB2/PCLK/SCOM2
PB3/PINT/SCOM3
PB3
PBPU
ST
CMOS
PINT
¾
ST
¾
SCOM3
SCOMC
¾
SCOM
PB4
PBPU
ST
CMOS
BZ
CO
¾
¾
PB5
PBPU
ST
CMOS
BZ
CO
¾
¾
PB6
PBPU
ST
CMOS
TC2
¾
ST
¾
PB7
PBPU
ST
CMOS
General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up.
General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up.
PB4/BZ
PB5/BZ
PB6/TC2
PB7
PC0
PCPU
ST
CMOS
OSC1
CO
AN
¾
PC1
PCPU
ST
CMOS
PC0/OSC1
PC1/OSC2
General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up.
Buzzer output
General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up.
Buzzer bar output
General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up.
External Timer 2 clock input
Oscillator pin
General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up.
CO
¾
CMOS
Oscillator pin
PCPU
ST
CMOS
General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up.
XT1
CO
¾
CMOS
Oscillator pin
PC3
PCPU
ST
CMOS
General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up.
XT2
CO
¾
LXT
PCn
PCPU
ST
CMOS
General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up.
PC6
PCPU
ST
CMOS
General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up.
AUD
CO
DACTRL
¾
AO
PC6/AUD
Oscillator pin
Audio output
PC7
PCPU
ST
NMOS
RES
CO
ST
¾
PD0
PDPU
ST
CMOS
General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up.
PWM0
PINMAP
¾
CMOS
PWM0 output
SDI0
CO
SIMCTL0
ST
¾
SPI0 serial data input
SDA
CO
SIMCTL0
ST
OD
I C data input or output
PC7/RES
Rev. 1.00
Software controlled 1/2 bias LCD COM
PC2
PC3/XT2
PD0/PWM0/SDI0/SDA
General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up.
Peripheral interrupt input, falling edge trigger
OSC2
PC2/XT1
PC4~PC5
2
I C serial clock input
8
General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up.
Reset input
2
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
Pin Name
PD1/PWM1/SDO0
Function
OPT
I/T
O/T
PD1
PDPU
ST
CMOS
General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up.
PWM1
PINMAP
¾
CMOS
PWM1 output
SDO0
CO
SIMCTL0
¾
CMOS
SPI0 serial data output
PD2
PDPU
ST
CMOS
General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up.
PWM2
PINMAP
¾
CMOS
PWM2 output
PD2/PWM2
PD3
PDPU
ST
CMOS
General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up.
PWM3
¾
¾
CMOS
PWM3 output
PD4
PDPU
ST
CMOS
General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up.
PWM0
PINMAP
¾
CMOS
PWM0 output
PD3/PWM3
PD4/PWM0
PD5
PDPU
ST
CMOS
General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up.
PWM1
PINMAP
¾
CMOS
PWM1 output
PD6
PDPU
ST
CMOS
General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up.
PD5/PWM1
PD6/TC1
TC1
PINMAP
ST
¾
PD7
PDPU
ST
CMOS
INT1
PINMAP
ST
¾
PE0
PEPU
ST
CMOS
General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up.
PFD
CO
PINMAP
¾
CMOS
PFD output
SCS1
CO
SPICTL0
ST
CMOS
SPI1 chip select pin
PD7/INT1
PE0/PFD/SCS1
PE1
PEPU
ST
CMOS
INT0
PINMAP
ST
¾
PE2
PEPU
ST
CMOS
PE1/INT0
PE2/TC0
PE3~PE4
Description
External Timer 1 clock input
General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up.
External interrupt 1 input
General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up.
External interrupt 0 input
General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up.
TC0
PINMAP
ST
¾
PEn
PEPU
ST
CMOS
General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up.
PE5
PEPU
ST
CMOS
General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up.
PWM2
PINMAP
¾
CMOS
PWM2 output
PE5/PWM2
External Timer 0 clock input
PF0~PF3
PFn
PFPU
ST
CMOS
General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up.
PG0~PG1
PGn
PGPU
ST
CMOS
General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up.
VDD
VDD
¾
PWR
¾
Power supply
VSS
VSS
¾
PWR
¾
Ground
Note:
I/T: Input type; O/T: Output type
OPT: Optional by configuration option (CO) or register option
PWR: Power; CO: Configuration option
ST: Schmitt Trigger input; CMOS: CMOS output; AN: analog input
SCOM: Software controlled LCD COM
HXT: High frequency crystal oscillator
LXT: Low frequency crystal oscillator
Rev. 1.00
9
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
HT56R25/HT56R26
Pin Name
Function
OPT
I/T
O/T
Description
PA0
PAPU
PAWK
ST
CMOS
General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up and wake-up.
AN0
ADCR
AN
¾
PA1
PAPU
PAWK
ST
CMOS
AN1
ADCR
AN
¾
PA2
PAPU
PAWK
ST
CMOS
AN2
ADCR
AN
¾
PA3
PAPU
PAWK
ST
CMOS
ST
¾
PFD output
A/D channel 3
PA0/AN0
PA1/AN1
PA2/AN2
PA3/PFD/AN3
PA4/INT0/AN4/VDDIO
PFD
CO
PINMAP
A/D channel 0
General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up and wake-up.
A/D channel 1
General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up and wake-up.
A/D channel 2
General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up and wake-up.
AN3
ADCR
AN
¾
PA4
PAPU
PAWK
ST
CMOS
INT0
PINMAP
ST
¾
External interrupt 0 input
AN4
ADCR
AN
¾
A/D channel 4
VDDIO
CO
PWR
¾
VDDIO power input
PA5
PAPU
PAWK
ST
CMOS
TC0
PINMAP
ST
¾
SDO1
CO
SPICTL0
¾
CMOS
AN5
ADCR
AN
¾
PA6
PAPU
PAWK
ST
CMOS
INT1
PINMAP
ST
¾
SDI1
CO
SPICTL0
¾
CMOS
AN6
ADCR
AN
¾
PA7
PAWK
ST
CMOS
TC1
PINMAP
ST
¾
SCK1
CO
SPICTL0
ST
CMOS
AN7
ADCR
AN
¾
PB0
PBPU
ST
CMOS
General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up.
SCK0
CO
SIMCTL0
ST
CMOS
SPI1 serial clock input or output
SCL
CO
SIMCTL0
ST
¾
SCOM0
SCOMC
¾
SCOM
PA5/TC0/SDO1/AN5
PA6/INT1/SDI1/AN6
PA7/TC1/SCK1/AN7
General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up and wake-up.
General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up and wake-up.
External Timer 0 clock input
SPI1 serial data output
A/D channel 5
General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up and wake-up.
External interrupt 1 input
SPI1 serial data input
A/D channel 6
General purpose I/O. Register enabled wake-up.
External Timer 1 clock input
SPI1 serial clock input or output
A/D channel 7
PB0/SCK0/SCL/SCOM0
Rev. 1.00
10
2
I C serial clock input
Software controlled 1/2 bias LCD COM
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
Pin Name
PB1/SCS0/SCOM1
PB2/PCLK/SCOM2
PB3/PINT/SCOM3
Function
OPT
I/T
O/T
PB1
PBPU
ST
CMOS
General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up.
SCS0
CO
SIMCTL0
ST
CMOS
SPI0 select control pin
SCOM1
SCOMC
¾
SCOM
Software controlled 1/2 bias LCD COM
PB2
PBPU
ST
CMOS
General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up.
PCLK
CO
SIMCTL0
¾
CMOS
Peripheral clock output
SCOM2
SCOMC
¾
SCOM
Software controlled 1/2 bias LCD COM
PB3
PBPU
ST
CMOS
General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up.
PINT
¾
ST
¾
SCOM3
SCOMC
¾
SCOM
Software controlled 1/2 bias LCD COM
PB4
PBPU
ST
CMOS
General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up.
BZ
CO
¾
¾
PB5
PBPU
ST
CMOS
BZ
CO
¾
¾
PB6
PBPU
ST
CMOS
TC2
¾
ST
¾
PB7
PBPU
ST
CMOS
PB4/BZ
PB5/BZ
PB6/TC2
PB7/TC3
TC3
¾
ST
¾
PC0
PCPU
ST
CMOS
OSC1
CO
AN
¾
PC0/OSC1
General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up.
External Timer 2 clock input
General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up.
External Timer 3 clock input
General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up.
Oscillator pin
ST
CMOS
General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up.
CO
¾
CMOS
Oscillator pin
PC2
PCPU
ST
CMOS
General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up.
XT1
CO
¾
CMOS
Oscillator pin
PC3
PCPU
ST
CMOS
General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up.
XT2
CO
¾
LXT
PCn
PCPU
ST
CMOS
General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up.
PC6
PCPU
ST
CMOS
General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up.
AUD
CO
DACTRL
¾
AO
PC7
PCPU
ST
NMOS
PC6/AUD
PC7/RES
Rev. 1.00
General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up.
Buzzer bar output
PCPU
PC3/XT2
PD1/PWM1/SDO0
Buzzer output
PC1
PC2/XT1
PD0/PWM0/SDI0/SDA
Peripheral interrupt input, falling edge trigger
OSC2
PC1/OSC2
PC4~PC5
Description
Oscillator pin
Audio output
General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up.
RES
CO
ST
¾
PD0
PDPU
ST
CMOS
General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up.
PWM0
PINMAP
¾
CMOS
PWM0 output
SDI0
CO
SIMCTL0
ST
¾
SPI0 serial data input
SDA
CO
SIMCTL0
ST
OD
I C data input or output
Reset input
2
PD1
PDPU
ST
CMOS
General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up.
PWM1
PINMAP
¾
CMOS
PWM1 output
SDO0
CO
SIMCTL0
¾
CMOS
SPI0 serial data output
11
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
Pin Name
Function
OPT
I/T
O/T
PD2
PDPU
ST
CMOS
General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up.
PWM2
PINMAP
¾
CMOS
PWM2 output
PD2/PWM2
Description
PD3
PDPU
ST
CMOS
General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up.
PWM3
¾
¾
CMOS
PWM3 output
PD4
PDPU
ST
CMOS
General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up.
PWM0
PINMAP
¾
CMOS
PWM0 output
PD5
PDPU
ST
CMOS
General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up.
PWM1
PINMAP
¾
CMOS
PWM1 output
PD6
PDPU
ST
CMOS
General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up.
TC1
PINMAP
ST
¾
PD3/PWM3
PD4/PWM0
PD5/PWM1
PD6/TC1
External Timer 1 clock input
PD7
PDPU
ST
CMOS
INT1
PINMAP
ST
¾
PE0
PEPU
ST
CMOS
General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up.
PFD
CO
PINMAP
¾
CMOS
PFD output
SCS1
CO
SPICTL0
ST
CMOS
SPI1 chip select pin
PE1
PEPU
ST
CMOS
General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up.
INT0
PINMAP
ST
¾
PE2
PEPU
ST
CMOS
TC0
PINMAP
ST
¾
PEn
PEPU
ST
CMOS
General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up.
PE5
PEPU
ST
CMOS
General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up.
PWM2
PINMAP
¾
CMOS
PWM2 output
PE6~PE7
PEn
PEPU
ST
CMOS
General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up.
PF0~PF7
PFn
PFPU
ST
CMOS
General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up.
PG0~PG1
PGn
PGPU
ST
CMOS
General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up.
VDD
VDD
¾
PWR
¾
Power supply
VSS
VSS
¾
PWR
¾
Ground
PD7/INT1
PE0/PFD/SCS1
PE1/INT0
PE2/TC0
PE3~PE4
PE5/PWM2
Note:
General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up.
External interrupt 1 input
External interrupt 0 input
General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up.
External Timer 0 clock input
I/T: Input type; O/T: Output type
OPT: Optional by configuration option (CO) or register option
PWR: Power; CO: Configuration option
ST: Schmitt Trigger input; CMOS: CMOS output; AN: analog input
SCOM: Software controlled LCD COM
HXT: High frequency crystal oscillator
LXT: Low frequency crystal oscillator
Absolute Maximum Ratings
Supply Voltage ...........................VSS-0.3V to VSS+6.0V
Storage Temperature ............................-50°C to 125°C
Input Voltage..............................VSS-0.3V to VDD+0.3V
IOL Total ................................................................80mA
Total Power Dissipation .....................................500mW
Operating Temperature...........................-40°C to 85°C
IOH Total..............................................................-80mA
Note: These are stress ratings only. Stresses exceeding the range specified under ²Absolute Maximum Ratings² may
cause substantial damage to the device. Functional operation of this device at other conditions beyond those listed
in the specification is not implied and prolonged exposure to extreme conditions may affect device reliability.
Rev. 1.00
12
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
D.C. Characteristics
Ta=25°C
Test Conditions
Symbol
Parameter
Min.
Typ.
Max.
Unit
fSYS=4MHz
2.2
¾
5.5
V
fSYS=8MHz
3.0
¾
5.5
V
fSYS=12MHz
4.5
¾
5.5
V
¾
170
250
mA
¾
380
570
mA
¾
240
360
mA
¾
490
730
mA
¾
440
660
mA
¾
900
1350
mA
¾
380
570
mA
¾
720
1080
mA
¾
370
550
mA
¾
680
1020
mA
VDD
VDD
IDD1
IDD2
IDD3
IDD4
IDD5
Operating Voltage
¾
Operating Current
(Crystal OSC, RC OSC)
3V
Operating Current
(Crystal OSC, RC OSC)
3V
Operating Current
(Crystal OSC, RC OSC)
3V
Operating Current
(EC Mode, Filter On)
3V
Operating Current
(EC Mode, Filter Off)
3V
Conditions
No load, fSYS=fM=1MHz
5V
No load, fSYS=fM=2MHz
5V
5V
No load, fSYS=fM=4MHz
(note 4)
No load, fSYS=fM=4MHz
5V
No load, fSYS=fM=4MHz
5V
IDD6
Operating Current
(Crystal OSC, RC OSC)
5V
No load, fSYS=fM=8MHz
¾
1.8
2.7
mA
IDD7
Operating Current
(Crystal OSC, RC OSC)
5V
No load, fSYS=fM=12MHz
¾
2.6
4.0
mA
Operating Current
(Slow Mode, fM=4MHz)
(Crystal OSC, RC OSC)
3V
¾
150
220
IDD8
mA
¾
340
510
mA
Operating Current
(Slow Mode, fM=4MHz)
(Crystal OSC, RC OSC)
3V
¾
180
270
mA
¾
400
600
mA
Operating Current
(Slow Mode, fM=4MHz)
(Crystal OSC, RC OSC)
3V
¾
270
400
mA
¾
560
840
mA
Operating Current
(Slow Mode, fM=8MHz)
(Crystal OSC, RC OSC)
3V
¾
240
360
mA
¾
540
810
mA
Operating Current
(Slow Mode, fM=8MHz)
(Crystal OSC, RC OSC)
3V
¾
320
480
mA
¾
680
1020
mA
Operating Current
(Slow Mode, fM=8MHz)
(Crystal OSC, RC OSC)
3V
¾
500
750
mA
¾
1000
1500
mA
Operating Current
fSYS= LXT or LIRC (note 1)
3V
¾
6
9
mA
¾
10
15
mA
¾
0.2
1.0
mA
¾
0.3
2.0
mA
¾
2
4
mA
¾
3
5
mA
IDD9
IDD10
IDD11
IDD12
IDD13
IDD14
ISTB1
ISTB2
Rev. 1.00
Standby Current ( Sleep)
(fSYS, fSUB, fS, fWDT=off)
Standby Current ( Sleep)
(fSYS, fWDT=fSUB= LXT or LIRC
No load, fSYS=fSLOW=500kHz
5V
No load, fSYS=fSLOW=1MHz
5V
No load, fSYS=fSLOW=2MHz
5V
No load, fSYS=fSLOW=1MHz
5V
No load, fSYS=fSLOW=2MHz
5V
No load, fSYS=fSLOW=4MHz
5V
No load, WDT off
5V
3V
5V
3V
5V
No load, system HALT,
WDT off
No load, system HALT,
WDT on
13
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
Ta=25°C
Test Conditions
Symbol
Parameter
VDD
Standby Current ( Idle)
(fSYS=on, fSYS=fM=4MHz, fWDT=off,
fS (note 2)=fSUB=LXT or LIRC
ISTB3
3V
5V
Min.
Typ.
Max.
Unit
¾
150
250
mA
¾
350
550
mA
Conditions
No load, system HALT,
WDT off, SPI or I2C on,
PCLK on, PCLK=fSYS/8
VIL1
Input Low Voltage for I/O Ports,
TC0/1/2/3 and INT0/1
¾
¾
0
¾
0.3VDD
V
VIH1
Input High Voltage for I/O Ports,
TC0/1/2/3 and INT0/1
¾
¾
0.7VDD
¾
VDD
V
VIL2
Input Low Voltage (RES)
¾
¾
0
¾
0.4VDD
V
VIH2
Input High Voltage (RES)
¾
¾
0.9VDD
¾
VDD
V
VLVR
Low Voltage Reset Voltage
VLVD
Low Voltage Detector Voltage
¾
Configuration option: 2.1V
1.98
2.1
2.22
V
¾
Configuration option: 3.15V
2.98
3.15
3.32
V
¾
Configuration option: 4.2V
3.98
4.2
4.42
V
¾
Configuration option: 2.2V
2.08
2.2
2.32
V
¾
Configuration option: 3.3V
3.12
3.3
3.50
V
¾
Configuration option: 4.4V
4.12
4.4
4.70
V
6
12
¾
mA
10
25
¾
mA
-2
-4
¾
mA
-5
-8
¾
mA
20
60
100
kW
10
30
50
kW
17.5
25.0
32.5
mA
3V
IOL1
I/O Port Sink Current
VOL=0.1VDD
5V
3V
IOH1
I/O Port Source Current
VOH=0.9VDD
5V
3V
Pull-high Resistance for I/O
Ports
5V
ISCOM
SCOM Operating Current
5V
VSCOM
VDD/2 Voltage for LCD COM
5V
RPH
¾
SCOMC, ISEL=0
SCOMC, ISEL=1
Note:
No load
35
50
65
mA
0.475
0.500
0.525
VDD
1. LXT is in slow start mode (RTCC.4=QOSC=1) for the D.C. current measurement.
2. fS is the internal clock for the Buzzer, RTC Interrupt, Time Base Interrupt and the WDT.
3. Both Timer/Event Counters are off. Timer filter is disabled for all test conditions.
4. All peripherals are in OFF condition if not mentioned at IDD, ISTB tests.
Rev. 1.00
14
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
A.C. Characteristics
Ta=25°C
Test Conditions
Symbol
Parameter
Min.
Typ.
Max.
Unit
2.2V~5.5V
32
¾
4000
kHz
3.0V~5.5V
32
¾
8000
kHz
4.5V~5.5V
32
¾
12000
kHz
VDD
System Clock
(Crystal OSC, RC OSC)
fSYS
f4MERC
System clock (ERC)
f4MIRC
System clock (HIRC)
fLXT
System clock LXT
fTIMER
Timer I/P Frequency
(TMR0/TMR1)
¾
Conditions
5V
R=150kW, Ta=25°C*
-2%
4
+2%
MHz
5V
R=150kW,
Ta=-40°C~+85°C
-8%
4
+8%
MHz
2.7V~ R=150kW,
5.5V Ta=-40°C~+85°C
-15%
4
+15%
MHz
5V
Ta=25°C
-2%
4
+2%
MHz
5V
Ta=-40°C~85°C
-5%
4
+5%
MHz
2.7V~
Ta=-40°C~85°C
5.5V
-10%
4
+10%
MHz
¾
32768
¾
Hz
2.2V~5.5V
0
¾
4000
kHz
3.0V~5.5V
0
¾
8000
kHz
4.5V~5.5V
0
¾
12000
kHz
2.2V~5.5V,
After Trim
28.8
32.0
35.2
kHz
¾
¾
¾
fLIRC
LIRC Oscillator
¾
tRES
External Reset Low Pulse Width
¾
¾
1
¾
¾
ms
tLVR
Low Voltage Reset Time
¾
¾
0.1
0.4
0.6
ms
tSST1
System Start-up Timer Period
¾
Power-on
¾
1024
¾
tSYS*
tSST2
System Start-up Timer Period for
XTAL or RTC oscillator
¾
Wake-up from Power
Down Mode
¾
1024
¾
tSYS*
tSST3
System Start-up Timer Period for
External RC or External Clock
¾
Wake-up from Power
Down Mode
¾
1
2
tSYS
tINT
Interrupt Pulse Width
¾
¾
1
¾
¾
ms
Note:
1. tSYS=1/fSYS1 or 1/fSYS2
2. * For f4MERC, as the resistor tolerance will influence the frequency a precision resistor is recommended.
3. To maintain the accuracy of the internal HIRC oscillator frequency, a 0.1mF decoupling capacitor should
be connected between VDD and VSS and located as close to the device as possible.
Rev. 1.00
15
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
ADC Characteristics
Ta=25°C
Test Conditions
Symbol
Parameter
VDD
Min.
Typ.
Max.
Unit
Conditions
DNL
A/C Differential Non-Linearity
5V
tAD=0.5ms
-2
¾
2
LSB
INL
ADC Integral Non-Linearity
5V
tAD=0.5ms
-4
¾
4
LSB
IADC
Additional Power Consumption
if A/D Converter is Used
3V
¾
0.50
0.75
mA
¾
1.00
1.50
mA
tAD
A/D Clock Period
¾
¾
0.5
¾
¾
ms
tADC
A/D Conversion Time
¾
¾
¾
16
¾
tAD
¾
5V
Power-on Reset Characteristics
Ta=25°C
Test Conditions
Symbol
Parameter
VDD
Conditions
Min.
Typ.
Max.
Unit
VPOR
VDD Start Voltage to Ensure
Power-on Reset
¾
¾
¾
¾
100
mV
RRVDD
VDD raising rate to Ensure
Power-on Reset
¾
¾
0.035
¾
¾
V/ms
tPOR
Minimum Time for VDD Stays at
VPOR to Ensure Power-on Reset
¾
¾
1
¾
¾
ms
V
D D
tP
O R
R R
V D D
V
P O R
T im e
Rev. 1.00
16
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
System Architecture
A key factor in the high-performance features of the
Holtek range of microcontrollers is attributed to the internal system architecture. The range of devices take advantage of the usual features found within RISC
microcontrollers providing increased speed of operation
and enhanced performance. The pipelining scheme is
implemented in such a way that instruction fetching and
instruction execution are overlapped, hence instructions
are effectively executed in one cycle, with the exception
of branch or call instructions. An 8-bit wide ALU is used
in practically all operations of the instruction set. It carries out arithmetic operations, logic operations, rotation,
increment, decrement, branch decisions, etc. The internal data path is simplified by moving data through the
Accumulator and the ALU. Certain internal registers are
implemented in the Data Memory and can be directly or
indirectly addressed. The simple addressing methods of
these registers along with additional architectural features ensure that a minimum of external components is
required to provide a functional I/O and A/D control system with maximum reliability and flexibility.
Program Counter is incremented at the beginning of the
T1 clock during which time a new instruction is fetched.
The remaining T2~T4 clocks carry out the decoding and
execution functions. In this way, one T1~T4 clock cycle
forms one instruction cycle. Although the fetching and
execution of instructions takes place in consecutive instruction cycles, the pipelining structure of the
microcontroller ensures that instructions are effectively
executed in one instruction cycle. The exception to this
are instructions where the contents of the Program
Counter are changed, such as subroutine calls or
jumps, in which case the instruction will take one more
instruction cycle to execute.
For instructions involving branches, such as jump or call
instructions, two instruction cycles are required to complete instruction execution. An extra cycle is required as
the program takes one cycle to first obtain the actual
jump or call address and then another cycle to actually
execute the branch. The requirement for this extra cycle
should be taken into account by programmers in timing
sensitive applications.
Clocking and Pipelining
The main system clock, derived from either a Crystal/Resonator or RC oscillator is subdivided into four internally generated non-overlapping clocks, T1~T4. The
O s c illa to r C lo c k
( S y s te m C lo c k )
P h a s e C lo c k T 1
P h a s e C lo c k T 2
P h a s e C lo c k T 3
P h a s e C lo c k T 4
P ro g ra m
C o u n te r
P ip e lin in g
P C
P C + 1
F e tc h In s t. (P C )
E x e c u te In s t. (P C -1 )
P C + 2
F e tc h In s t. (P C + 1 )
E x e c u te In s t. (P C )
F e tc h In s t. (P C + 2 )
E x e c u te In s t. (P C + 1 )
System Clocking and Pipelining
M O V A ,[1 2 H ]
2
C A L L D E L A Y
3
C P L [1 2 H ]
4
:
5
:
6
1
D E L A Y :
F e tc h In s t. 1
E x e c u te In s t. 1
F e tc h In s t. 2
E x e c u te In s t. 2
F e tc h In s t. 3
F lu s h P ip e lin e
F e tc h In s t. 6
E x e c u te In s t. 6
F e tc h In s t. 7
N O P
Instruction Fetching
Rev. 1.00
17
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
Program Counter
neither readable nor writeable. At a subroutine call or interrupt acknowledge signal, the contents of the Program
Counter are pushed onto the stack. At the end of a subroutine or an interrupt routine, signaled by a return instruction, RET or RETI, the Program Counter is restored
to its previous value from the stack. After a device reset,
the Stack Pointer will point to the top of the stack.
During program execution, the Program Counter is used
to keep track of the address of the next instruction to be
executed. It is automatically incremented by one each
time an instruction is executed except for instructions,
such as ²JMP² or ²CALL² that demand a jump to a
non-consecutive Program Memory address. Note that
the Program Counter width varies with the Program
Memory capacity depending upon which device is selected. However, it must be noted that only the lower 8
bits, known as the Program Counter Low Register, are
directly addressable by user.
P ro g ra m
T o p o f S ta c k
B o tto m
HT56R22
PC10~PC8
HT56R23
PC11~PC8
HT56R24
PC12~PC8
HT56R25
PC13~PC8
HT56R26
PC14~PC8
PCL Register
o f S ta c k
S ta c k L e v e l 8
Stack Levels
HT56R22
6
HT56R23
HT56R24
HT56R25
HT56R26
12
If the stack is full and an enabled interrupt takes place,
the interrupt request flag will be recorded but the acknowledge signal will be inhibited. When the Stack
Pointer is decremented, by RET or RETI, the interrupt
will be serviced. This feature prevents stack overflow allowing the programmer to use the structure more easily.
However, when the stack is full, a CALL subroutine instruction can still be executed which will result in a stack
overflow. Precautions should be taken to avoid such
cases which might cause unpredictable program
branching.
PCL7~PCL0
The lower byte of the Program Counter, known as the
Program Counter Low register or PCL, is available for
program control and is a readable and writeable register. By transferring data directly into this register, a short
program jump can be executed directly, however, as
only this low byte is available for manipulation, the
jumps are limited to the present page of memory, that is
256 locations. When such program jumps are executed
it should also be noted that a dummy cycle will be inserted.
Arithmetic and Logic Unit - ALU
The arithmetic-logic unit or ALU is a critical area of the
microcontroller that carries out arithmetic and logic operations of the instruction set. Connected to the main
microcontroller data bus, the ALU receives related instruction codes and performs the required arithmetic or
logical operations after which the result will be placed in
the specified register. As these ALU calculation or operations may result in carry, borrow or other status
changes, the status register will be correspondingly updated to reflect these changes. The ALU supports the
following functions:
The lower byte of the Program Counter is fully accessible under program control. Manipulating the PCL might
cause program branching, so an extra cycle is needed
to pre-fetch. Further information on the PCL register can
be found in the Special Function Register section.
· Arithmetic operations: ADD, ADDM, ADC, ADCM,
Stack
SUB, SUBM, SBC, SBCM, DAA
· Logic operations: AND, OR, XOR, ANDM, ORM,
This is a special part of the memory which is used to
save the contents of the Program Counter only. The
stack is neither part of the Data or Program Memory
space, and is neither readable nor writeable. The activated level is indexed by the Stack Pointer, SP, and is
Rev. 1.00
P ro g ra m
M e m o ry
S ta c k L e v e l 3
Device
Program Counter
Program Counter
High Byte
S ta c k L e v e l 1
S ta c k L e v e l 2
S ta c k
P o in te r
When executing instructions requiring jumps to
non-consecutive addresses such as a jump instruction,
a subroutine call, interrupt or reset, etc., the
microcontroller manages program control by loading the
required address into the Program Counter. For conditional skip instructions, once the condition has been
met, the next instruction, which has already been
fetched during the present instruction execution, is discarded and a dummy cycle takes its place while the correct instruction is obtained.
Device
C o u n te r
XORM, CPL, CPLA
· Rotation RRA, RR, RRCA, RRC, RLA, RL, RLCA,
RLC
· Increment and Decrement INCA, INC, DECA, DEC
18
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
· Branch decision, JMP, SZ, SZA, SNZ, SIZ, SDZ,
Special Vectors
SIZA, SDZA, CALL, RET, RETI
Within the Program Memory, certain locations are reserved for special usage such as reset and interrupts.
Program Memory
· Reset Vector
This vector is reserved for use by the device reset for
program initialisation. After a device reset is initiated, the
program will jump to this location and begin execution.
The Program Memory is the location where the user
code or program is stored. The device is supplied with
One-Time Programmable, OTP, memory where users
can program their application code into the device. By
using the appropriate programming tools, OTP devices
offer users the flexibility to freely develop their applications which may be useful during debug or for products
requiring frequent upgrades or program changes.
· External interrupt 0/1 vector
This vector is used by the external interrupt. If the external interrupt pin on the device receives an edge
transition, the program will jump to this location and
begin execution if the external interrupt is enabled and
the stack is not full. The external interrupt active edge
transition type, whether high to low, low to high or both
is specified in the INTEDGE register.
Structure
· Timer/Event 0/1 counter interrupt vector
The Program Memory has a capacity of 2K´14 to
32K´16. The Program Memory is addressed by the Program Counter and also contains data, table information
and interrupt entries. Table data, which can be setup in
any location within the Program Memory, is addressed
by separate table pointer registers.
Device
This internal vector is used by the Timer/Event Counters. If a Timer/Event Counter overflow occurs, the
program will jump to its respective location and begin
execution if the associated Timer/Event Counter interrupt is enabled and the stack is not full.
· SPI/I2C interrupt vector
This internal vector is used by the SPI/I2C interrupt.
When either an SPI or I2C bus, dependent upon which
one is selected, requires data transfer, the program
will jump to this location and begin execution if the
SPI/I2C interrupt is enabled and the stack is not full.
Capacity
HT56R22
2K´14
HT56R23
4K´15
HT56R24
8K´16
HT56R25
16K´16
HT56R26
32K´16
H T 5 6 R 2 2
H T 5 6 R 2 3
H T 5 6 R 2 4
H T 5 6 R 2 5
H T 5 6 R 2 6
0 0 0 0 H
R e s e t
R e s e t
R e s e t
R e s e t
R e s e t
0 0 0 4 H
E x te rn a l 0 In te rru p t
E x te rn a l 0 In te rru p t
E x te rn a l 0 In te rru p t
E x te rn a l 0 In te rru p t
E x te rn a l 0 In te rru p t
0 0 0 8 H
E x te rn a l 1 In te rru p t
E x te rn a l 1 In te rru p t
E x te rn a l 1 In te rru p t
E x te rn a l 1 In te rru p t
E x te rn a l 1 In te rru p t
0 0 0 C H
T im e r 0 In te r r u p t
T im e r 0 In te r r u p t
T im e r 0 In te r r u p t
T im e r 0 In te r r u p t
T im e r 0 In te r r u p t
0 0 1 0 H
T im e r 1 In te r r u p t
T im e r 1 In te r r u p t
T im e r 1 In te r r u p t
T im e r 1 In te r r u p t
T im e r 1 In te r r u p t
0 0 1 4 H
0 0 1 8 H
7 F F H
2
2
S P I/I C In te rru p t
S P I/I C In te rru p t
T im e
R
A
E x te
B a s e In te rru p t,
T C In te rru p t,
/D In te rru p t,
r n a l P e r ip h e r a l
In te rru p t,
S P I1 In te rru p t
T im e
R
A
E x te
B a s e In te rru p t,
T C In te rru p t,
/D In te rru p t,
r n a l P e r ip h e r a l
In te rru p t,
T im e r 2 In te r r u p t,
S P I1 In te rru p t
2
S P I/I C In te rru p t
T im e
R
A
E x te
B a s e In te rru p t,
T C In te rru p t,
/D In te rru p t,
r n a l P e r ip h e r a l
In te rru p t,
T im e r 2 In te r r u p t,
S P I1 In te rru p t
2
S P I/I C In te rru p t
T im e
R
A
E x te
B a s e In te rru p t,
T C In te rru p t,
/D In te rru p t,
r n a l P e r ip h e r a l
In te rru p t,
T im e r 2 In te r r u p t,
T im e r 3 In te r r u p t,
S P I1 In te rru p t
S P I/I2 C In te rru p t
T im e
R
A
E x te
B a s e In te rru p t,
T C In te rru p t,
/D In te rru p t,
r n a l P e r ip h e r a l
In te rru p t,
T im e r 2 In te r r u p t,
T im e r 3 In te r r u p t,
S P I1 In te rru p t
1 4 b its
F F F H
1 5 b its
1 F F F H
1 6 b its
3 F F F H
1 6 b its
7 F F F H
1 6 b its
Program Memory Structure
Rev. 1.00
19
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
· Multifunction Interrupt vector
Table Program Example
The Multi-function Interrupt vector is shared by several internal functions such as a Time Base overflow, a
Real Time Clock overflow, an A/D converter conversion completion, a falling edge appearing on the External Peripheral interrupt pin, a Timer/Event Counter
2 or a Timer/Event Counter 3 overflow, a SPI data
transfer completion. The program will jump to this location and begin execution if the relevant interrupt is
enabled and the stack is not full.
The accompanying example shows how the table
pointer and table data is defined and retrieved from the
device. This example uses raw table data located in the
last page which is stored there using the ORG statement. The value at this ORG statement is ²700H² which
refers to the start address of the last page within the 2K
Program Memory of the HT56R22 microcontrollers. The
table pointer is setup here to have an initial value of
²06H². This will ensure that the first data read from the
data table will be at the Program Memory address
²706H² or 6 locations after the start of the last page.
Note that the value for the table pointer is referenced to
the first address of the present page if the ²TABRDC
[m]² instruction is being used. The high byte of the table
data which in this case is equal to zero will be transferred to the TBLH register automatically when the
²TABRDL [m]² instruction is executed.
Look-up Table
Any location within the Program Memory can be defined
as a look-up table where programmers can store fixed
data. To use the look-up table, the table pointer must
first be setup by placing the lower order address of the
look up data to be retrieved in the table pointer register,
TBLP. This register defines the lower 8-bit address of
the look-up table.
After setting up the table pointer, the table data can be
retrieved from the current Program Memory page or last
Program Memory page using the ²TABRDC[m]² or
²TABRDL [m]² instructions, respectively. When these instructions are executed, the lower order table byte from
the Program Memory will be transferred to the user defined Data Memory register [m] as specified in the instruction. The higher order table data byte from the
Program Memory will be transferred to the TBLH special
register. Any unused bits in this transferred higher order
byte will be read as ²0².
Because the TBLH register is a read-only register and
cannot be restored, care should be taken to ensure its
protection if both the main routine and Interrupt Service
Routine use the table read instructions. If using the table
read instructions, the Interrupt Service Routines may
change the value of TBLH and subsequently cause errors if used again by the main routine. As a rule it is recommended that simultaneous use of the table read
instructions should be avoided. However, in situations
where simultaneous use cannot be avoided, the interrupts should be disabled prior to the execution of any
main routine table-read instructions. Note that all table
related instructions require two instruction cycles to
complete their operation.
The following diagram illustrates the addressing/data
flow of the look-up table:
L a s t p a g e o r
p re s e n t p a g e
P C x ~ P C 8
P ro g ra m
H ig h B y te
A d d re s s
P C
T B L P R e g is te r
M e m o ry
D a ta
1 4 ~ 1 6 b its
U s e r S e le c te d
R e g is te r
R e g is te r T B L H
H ig h B y te
Instruction
L o w
B y te
Table Location Bits
b14
b13
b12
b11
b10
b9
b8
TABRDC [m] PC14 PC13 PC12 PC11 PC10 PC9 PC8
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
@7
@6
@5
@4
@3
@2
@1
@0
Table Location
Note:
PC14~PC8: Current Program Counter bits
@7~@0: Table Pointer TBLP bits
For the HT56R22, the Table address location is 11 bits, i.e. from b10~b0.
For the HT56R23, the Table address location is 12 bits, i.e. from b11~b0.
For the HT56R24, the Table address location is 13 bits, i.e. from b12~b0.
For the HT56R25, the Table address location is 14 bits, i.e. from b13~b0.
For the HT56R26, the Table address location is 15 bits, i.e. from b14~b0.
Rev. 1.00
20
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
Table Read Program Example:
tempreg1 db ?
; temporary register #1
tempreg2 db ?
; temporary register #2
:
:
mov a,06h
; initialise table pointer - note that this address
; is referenced
mov tblp,a
:
:
; to the last page or present page
tabrdl
;
;
;
;
tempreg1
dec tblp
tabrdl
transfers value in table referenced by table pointer
to tempregl
data at prog. memory address ²706H² transferred to
tempreg1 and TBLH
; reduce value of table pointer by one
tempreg2
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
transfers value in table referenced by table pointer
to tempreg2
data at prog.memory address ²705H² transferred to
tempreg2 and TBLH
in this example the data ²1AH² is transferred to
tempreg1 and data ²0FH² to register tempreg2
the value ²00H² will be transferred to the high byte
register TBLH
:
:
org 700h
dc
; sets initial address of last page
00Ah, 00Bh, 00Ch, 00Dh, 00Eh, 00Fh, 01Ah, 01Bh
:
:
Data Memory
The Data Memory is a volatile area of 8-bit wide RAM
internal memory and is the location where temporary information is stored.
The two sections of Data Memory, the Special Purpose
and General Purpose Data Memory are located at consecutive locations. All are implemented in RAM and are 8
bits wide but the length of each memory section is dictated by the type of microcontroller chosen. The start address of the Data Memory for all devices is the address
²00H².
Structure
Divided into two sections, the first of these is an area of
RAM where special function registers are located. These
registers have fixed locations and are necessary for correct operation of the device. Many of these registers can
be read from and written to directly under program control, however, some remain protected from user manipulation. The second area of Data Memory is reserved for
general purpose use. All locations within this area are
read and write accessible under program control.
Device
Capacity
Banks
HT56R22
128´8
0, 2
HT56R23
256´8
0, 2
HT56R24
640´8
0, 2~5
HT56R25
1152´8
0, 2~9
HT56R26
2304´8
0, 2~18
Rev. 1.00
All microcontroller programs require an area of
read/write memory where temporary data can be stored
and retrieved for use later. It is this area of RAM memory
that is known as General Purpose Data Memory. This
area of Data Memory is fully accessible by the user program for both read and write operations. By using the
²SET [m].i² and ²CLR [m].i² instructions individual bits
can be set or reset under program control giving the
user a large range of flexibility for bit manipulation in the
Data Memory.
For some devices, the Data Memory is subdivided into
banks, which are selected using a Bank Pointer. Only
data in Bank 0 can be directly addressed, data in Bank
2~n must be indirectly addressed.
21
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
H T 5 6 R 2 2
B a n k 0
B a n k 2
IA R 0
0 0 H
M P 0
0 1 H
H T 5 6 R 2 5
B a n k 0
B a n k 2 ~ 9
IA R 0
M P 0
3 F H
4 0 H
T o ta l 1 2 8 b y te s
S p e c ia l
P u rp o s e
R e g is te r s
0 0 H
IA R 0
IA R 0
0 1 H
M P 0
M P 0
7 F H
8 0 H
G e n e ra l
P u rp o s e
R e g is te r s
T o ta l 1 1 5 2 b y te s
7 F H
S p e c ia l
P u rp o s e
R e g is te r s
G e n e ra l
P u rp o s e
R e g is te r s
F F H
H T 5 6 R 2 3
B a n k 0
B a n k 2
0 0 H
IA R 0
IA R 0
0 1 H
M P 0
M P 0
7 F H
8 0 H
T o ta l 2 5 6 b y te s
H T 5 6 R 2 6
B a n k 0
B a n k 2 ~ 1 8
S p e c ia l
P u rp o s e
R e g is te r s
0 0 H
IA R 0
IA R 0
0 1 H
M P 0
M P 0
7 F H
8 0 H
G e n e ra l
P u rp o s e
R e g is te r s
T o ta l 2 3 0 4 b y te s
F F H
S p e c ia l
P u rp o s e
R e g is te r s
G e n e ra l
P u rp o s e
R e g is te r s
F F H
H T 5 6 R 2 4
B a n k 0
B a n k 2 ~ 5
0 0 H
IA R 0
IA R 0
0 1 H
M P 0
M P 0
7 F H
8 0 H
T o ta l 6 4 0 b y te s
S p e c ia l
P u rp o s e
R e g is te r s
G e n e ra l
P u rp o s e
R e g is te r s
F F H
Data Memory Structure
Note:
Most of the Data Memory bits can be directly manipulated using the ²SET [m].i² and ²CLR [m].i² with the exception of a few dedicated bits. The Data Memory can also be accessed through the memory pointer registers.
Rev. 1.00
22
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
Special Purpose Data Memory
dressing, where the actual memory address is specified. Actions on the IAR0 and IAR1 registers will result in
no actual read or write operation to these registers but
rather to the memory location specified by their corresponding Memory Pointer, MP0 or MP1. Acting as a
pair, IAR0 with MP0 and IAR1 with MP1 can together
access data from the Data Memory. As the Indirect Addressing Registers are not physically implemented,
reading the Indirect Addressing Registers indirectly will
return a result of ²00H² and writing to the registers indirectly will result in no operation.
This area of Data Memory is where registers, necessary
for the correct operation of the microcontroller, are
stored. Most of the registers are both readable and
writeable but some are protected and are readable only,
the details of which are located under the relevant Special Function Register section. Note that for locations
that are unused, any read instruction to these addresses
will return the value ²00H².
Special Function Registers
Memory Pointers - MP0, MP1
To ensure successful operation of the microcontroller,
certain internal registers are implemented in the Data
Memory area. These registers ensure correct operation
of internal functions such as timers, interrupts, etc., as
well as external functions such as I/O data control. The
location of these registers within the Data Memory begins at the address ²00H² and are mapped into both
Bank 0 and Bank 1. Any unused Data Memory locations
between these special function registers and the point
where the General Purpose Memory begins is reserved
and attempting to read data from these locations will return a value of ²00H².
Two Memory Pointers, known as MP0 and MP1 are provided. These Memory Pointers are physically implemented in the Data Memory and can be manipulated in
the same way as normal registers providing a convenient way with which to indirectly address and track
data. MP0 can only be used to indirectly address data in
Bank 0 while MP1 can be used to address data in Bank
0 and Bank1. When any operation to the relevant Indirect Addressing Registers is carried out, the actual address that the microcontroller is directed to, is the
address specified by the related Memory Pointer. Note
that for the HT56R22 device, bit 7 of the Memory
Pointers is not required to address the full memory
space. When bit 7 of the Memory Pointers for this device
is read, a value of ²1² will be returned. Note that indirect
addressing using MP1 and IAR1 must be used to access
any data in Bank 1. The following example shows how to
clear a section of four Data Memory locations already defined as locations adres1 to adres4.
Indirect Addressing Registers - IAR0, IAR1
The Indirect Addressing Registers, IAR0 and IAR1, although having their locations in normal RAM register
space, do not actually physically exist as normal registers. The method of indirect addressing for RAM data
manipulation uses these Indirect Addressing Registers
and Memory Pointers, in contrast to direct memory ad-
· Indirect Addressing Program Example
data .section ¢data¢
adres1 db ?
adres2 db ?
adres3 db ?
adres4 db ?
block db ?
code .section at 0 code
org 00h
start:
mov
mov
mov
mov
a,04h
block,a
a,offset adres1
mp0,a
; setup size of block
loop:
clr
inc
sdz
jmp
IAR0
mp0
block
loop
; clear the data at address defined by MP0
; increment memory pointer
; check if last memory location has been cleared
; Accumulator loaded with first RAM address
; setup memory pointer with first RAM address
continue:
The important point to note here is that in the example shown above, no reference is made to specific Data Memory
addresses.
Rev. 1.00
23
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
H T 5 6 R 2 2
0 0 H
0 1 H
0 2 H
0 3 H
0 4 H
0 5 H
0 6 H
0 7 H
0 8 H
0 9 H
0 A H
0 B H
0 C H
0 D H
0 E H
0 F H
1 0 H
1 1 H
1 2 H
1 3 H
1 4 H
1 5 H
1 6 H
1 7 H
1 8 H
1 9 H
1 A H
1 B H
1 C H
1 D H
1 E H
1 F H
2 0 H
2 1 H
2 2 H
2 3 H
2 4 H
2 5 H
2 6 H
2 7 H
2 8 H
2 9 H
2 A H
2 B H
2 C H
2 D H
2 E H
2 F H
3 0 H
3 1 H
3 2 H
3 3 H
3 4 H
3 5 H
3 6 H
3 7 H
3 8 H
3 9 H
3 A H
3 B H
3 C H
3 C H
3 E H
3 F H
4 0 H
7 F H
IA R 0
M P 0
IA R 1
M P 1
B P
A C C
P C L
T B L P
T B L H
R T C C
S T A T U S
IN T C 0
L C D C
T M R 0
T M R 0 C
T M R 1
T M R 1 C
P A
P A C
P B
P B C
P C
P C C
P D
P D C
P W M 0 L
P W M 0 H
P W M 1 L
P W M 1 H
IN T C 1
A D P C R
P W M 2 L
P W M 2 H
C
IN
S
S
D
S
S
S IM A
A D R L
A D R H
A D C R
A C S R
L K M O
P A W U
P A P U
P B P U
P C P U
P D P U
T E D G
P IC T L
P IC T L
S P ID R
A C T R
M IS C
M F IC 0
M F IC 1
IM C T L
IM C T L
S IM D R
R /S IM
D A L
D A H
D
E
0
1
L
0
1
C T L 2
0 0 H
0 1 H
0 2 H
0 3 H
0 4 H
0 5 H
0 6 H
0 7 H
0 8 H
0 9 H
0 A H
0 B H
0 C H
0 D H
0 E H
0 F H
1 0 H
1 1 H
1 2 H
1 3 H
1 4 H
1 5 H
1 6 H
1 7 H
1 8 H
1 9 H
1 A H
1 B H
1 C H
1 D H
1 E H
1 F H
2 0 H
2 1 H
2 2 H
2 3 H
2 4 H
2 5 H
2 6 H
2 7 H
2 8 H
2 9 H
2 A H
2 B H
2 C H
2 D H
2 E H
2 F H
3 0 H
3 1 H
3 2 H
3 3 H
3 4 H
3 5 H
3 6 H
3 7 H
3 8 H
3 9 H
3 A H
3 B H
3 C H
3 C H
3 E H
3 F H
4 0 H
4 1 H
4 2 H
4 3 H
4 4 H
4 5 H
4 6 H
4 7 H
4 8 H
4 9 H
5 A H
H T 5 6 R 2 3 /H T 5 6 R 2 4
IA R 0
M P 0
IA R 1
M P 1
B P
A C C
P C L
T B L P
T B L H
R T C C
S T A T U S
IN T C 0
L C D C
T M R 0
T M R 0 C
T M R 1 H
T M R 1 L
T M R 1 C
P A
P A C
P B
P B C
P C
P C C
P D
P D C
P W M 0 L
P W M 0 H
P W M 1 L
P W M 1 H
IN T C 1
A D P C R
P W M 2 L
P W M 2 H
P W M 3 L
P W M 3 H
A D R L
A D R H
A D C R
A C S R
C L K M O D
P A W U
P A P U
P B P U
P C P U
P D P U
IN T E D G E
S P IC T L 0
S P IC T L 1
S P ID R
D A C T R L
M IS C
M F IC 0
M F IC 1
S IM C T L 0
S IM C T L 1
S IM D R
S IM A R /S IM C T L 2
T M R 2
T M R 2 C
H T 5 6 R 2 5 /H T 5 6 R 2 6
0 0 H
0 1 H
0 2 H
0 3 H
0 4 H
0 5 H
0 6 H
0 7 H
0 8 H
0 9 H
0 A H
0 B H
0 C H
0 D H
0 E H
0 F H
1 0 H
1 1 H
1 2 H
1 3 H
1 4 H
1 5 H
1 6 H
1 7 H
1 8 H
1 9 H
1 A H
1 B H
1 C H
1 D H
1 E H
1 F H
2 0 H
2 1 H
2 2 H
2 3 H
2 4 H
2 5 H
2 6 H
2 7 H
2 8 H
2 9 H
2 A H
2 B H
2 C H
2 D H
2 E H
2 F H
3 0 H
3 1 H
3 2 H
3 3 H
3 4 H
3 5 H
3 6 H
3 7 H
3 8 H
3 9 H
3 A H
3 B H
3 C H
3 C H
3 E H
3 F H
4 0 H
4 1 H
4 2 H
4 3 H
4 4 H
4 5 H
4 6 H
4 7 H
4 8 H
4 9 H
5 A H
D A L
D A H
P E
P E C
P F
P F C
P E P U
P F P U
P IN M A P
IA
M
IA
M
R 0
P 0
R 1
P 1
B P
A C C
P C L
T B L P
T B L H
R T C C
S T A T U S
IN T C 0
L C D C
T M R 0
T M R 0 C
T M R 1 H
T M R 1 L
T M R 1 C
P A
P A C
P B
P B C
P C
P C C
P D
P D C
P W M 0 L
P W M 0 H
P W M 1 L
P W M 1 H
IN T C 1
A D P C R
P W M 2 L
P W M 2 H
P W M 3 L
P W M 3 H
A D R L
A D R H
A D C R
A C S R
C L K M O D
P A W U
P A P U
P B P U
P C P U
P D P U
IN T E D G E
S P IC T L 0
S P IC T L 1
S P ID R
D A C T R L
M IS C
M F IC 0
M F IC 1
S IM C T L 0
S IM C T L 1
S IM D R
S IM A R /S IM C T L 2
T M R 2
T M R 2 C
T M R 3
T M R 3 C
D A L
D A H
P E
P E C
P F
P F C
P G
P G C
P E P U
P F P U
P G P U
P IN M A P
7 F H
7 F H
: U n u s e d , re a d a s "0 0 "
Special Purpose Data Memory
Rev. 1.00
24
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
Accumulator - ACC
Bank Pointer - BP
The Accumulator is central to the operation of any
microcontroller and is closely related with operations
carried out by the ALU. The Accumulator is the place
where all intermediate results from the ALU are stored.
Without the Accumulator it would be necessary to write
the result of each calculation or logical operation such
as addition, subtraction, shift, etc., to the Data Memory
resulting in higher programming and timing overheads.
Data transfer operations usually involve the temporary
storage function of the Accumulator; for example, when
transferring data between one user defined register and
another, it is necessary to do this by passing the data
through the Accumulator as no direct transfer between
two registers is permitted.
Depending upon which device is used, the Program and
Data Memory is divided into several banks. Selecting
the required Program and Data Memory area is
achieved using the Bank Pointer.
The Data Memory is initialised to Bank 0 after a reset,
except for a WDT time-out reset in the Power Down
Mode, in which case, the Data Memory bank remains
unaffected. It should be noted that the Special Function
Data Memory is not affected by the bank selection,
which means that the Special Function Registers can be
accessed from within any bank. Directly addressing the
Data Memory will always result in Bank 0 being accessed irrespective of the value of the Bank Pointer. Accessing data from banks other than Bank 0 must be
implemented using Indirect addressing.
Program Counter Low Register - PCL
As both the Program Memory and Data Memory share
the same Bank Pointer Register, care must be taken
during programming.
To provide additional program control functions, the low
byte of the Program Counter is made accessible to programmers by locating it within the Special Purpose area
of the Data Memory. By manipulating this register, direct
jumps to other program locations are easily implemented. Loading a value directly into this PCL register
will cause a jump to the specified Program Memory location, however, as the register is only 8-bit wide, only
jumps within the current Program Memory page are permitted. When such operations are used, note that a
dummy cycle will be inserted.
Device
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
HT56R22
HT56R23
¾
¾
¾
¾
¾
¾
DMBP1
DMBP0
HT56R24
¾
¾
¾
¾
¾
DMBP2
DMBP1
DMBP0
HT56R25
¾
¾
PMBP0
¾
DMBP3
DMBP2
DMBP1
DMBP0
HT56R26
¾
PMBP1
PMBP0
DMBP4
DMBP3
DMBP2
DMBP1
DMBP0
BP Registers List
· BP Register
¨
HT56R22/HT56R23
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Name
¾
¾
¾
¾
¾
¾
DMBP1
DMBP0
R/W
¾
¾
¾
¾
¾
¾
R/W
R/W
POR
¾
¾
¾
¾
¾
¾
0
0
Bit 7 ~ 2
Unimplemented, read as ²0²
Bit 1 ~ 0
DMBP1 ~ DMBP0: Select Data Memory Banks
00: Bank 0
01: Reserved
10: Bank 2
11: Undefined
Rev. 1.00
25
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
¨
HT56R24
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Name
¾
¾
¾
¾
¾
DMBP2
DMBP1
DMBP0
R/W
¾
¾
¾
¾
¾
R/W
R/W
R/W
POR
¾
¾
¾
¾
¾
0
0
0
Bit 7 ~ 3
Unimplemented, read as ²0²
Bit 2 ~ 0
DMBP2 ~ DMBP0: Select Data Memory Banks
000: Bank 0
001: Reserved
010: Bank 2
011: Bank 3
100: Bank 4
101: Bank 5
110~111: Undefined
¨
HT56R25
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Name
¾
¾
PMBP0
¾
DMBP3
DMBP2
DMBP1
DMBP0
R/W
¾
¾
R/W
¾
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
POR
¾
¾
¾
¾
¾
¾
0
0
Bit 7 ~ 2
Unimplemented, read as ²0²
Bit5
PMBP0: Select Program Memory Banks
0: Bank 0, Program Memory Address is from 0000H ~ 1FFFH
1: Bank 1, Program Memory Address is from 2000H ~ 3FFFH
Bit4
Unimplemented, read as ²0²
Bit3 ~ 0
DMBP3 ~ DMBP0: Select Data Memory Banks
0000: Bank 0
0001: Reserved
0010: Bank 2
0011: Bank 3
:
:
1001: Bank 9
1010~1111: Undefined
¨
HT56R26
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Name
¾
PMBP1
PMBP0
DMBP4
DMBP3
DMBP2
DMBP1
DMBP0
R/W
¾
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
POR
¾
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7 ~ 2
Unimplemented, read as ²0²
Bit6~5
PMBP1, PMBP0: Select Program Memory Banks
00: Bank 0, Program Memory Address is from 0000H ~ 1FFFH
01: Bank 1, Program Memory Address is from 2000H ~ 3FFFH
10: Bank 2, Program Memory Address is from 4000H ~ 5FFFH
11: Bank 3, Program Memory Address is from 6000H ~ 7FFFH
Bit4 ~ 0
DMBP4 ~ DMBP0: Select Data Memory Banks
00000: Bank 0
00001: Reserved
00010: Bank 2
00011: Bank 3
:
:
10010: Bank 18
10011~11111: Undefined
Rev. 1.00
26
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
Status Register - STATUS
tine can change the status register, precautions must be
taken to correctly save it. Note that bits 0~3 of the
STATUS register are both readable and writeable bits.
This 8-bit register contains the zero flag (Z), carry flag
(C), auxiliary carry flag (AC), overflow flag (OV), power
down flag (PDF), and watchdog time-out flag (TO).
These arithmetic/logical operation and system management flags are used to record the status and operation of
the microcontroller.
Input/Output Ports and Control Registers
Within the area of Special Function Registers, the port
PA, PB, etc data I/O registers and their associated control register PAC, PBC, etc play a prominent role. These
registers are mapped to specific addresses within the
Data Memory as shown in the Data Memory table. The
data I/O registers, are used to transfer the appropriate
output or input data on the port. The control registers
specifies which pins of the port are set as inputs and
which are set as outputs. To setup a pin as an input, the
corresponding bit of the control register must be set
high, for an output it must be set low. During program initialisation, it is important to first setup the control registers to specify which pins are outputs and which are
inputs before reading data from or writing data to the I/O
ports. One flexible feature of these registers is the ability
to directly program single bits using the ²SET [m].i² and
²CLR [m].i² instructions. The ability to change I/O pins
from output to input and vice versa by manipulating specific bits of the I/O control registers during normal program operation is a useful feature of these devices.
With the exception of the TO and PDF flags, bits in the
status register can be altered by instructions like most
other registers. Any data written into the status register
will not change the TO or PDF flag. In addition, operations related to the status register may give different results due to the different instruction operations. The TO
flag can be affected only by a system power-up, a WDT
time-out or by executing the ²CLR WDT² or ²HALT² instruction. The PDF flag is affected only by executing the
²HALT² or ²CLR WDT² instruction or during a system
power-up.
The Z, OV, AC and C flags generally reflect the status of
the latest operations.
In addition, on entering an interrupt sequence or executing a subroutine call, the status register will not be
pushed onto the stack automatically. If the contents of
the status registers are important and if the interrupt rou-
· STATUS Register
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Name
¾
¾
TO
PDF
OV
Z
AC
C
R/W
¾
¾
R
R
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
POR
¾
¾
0
0
x
x
x
x
²x² unknown
Bit 7, 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Rev. 1.00
Unimplemented, read as ²0²
TO: Watchdog Time-Out flag
0: After power up or executing the ²CLR WDT² or ²HALT² instruction
1: A watchdog time-out occurred.
PDF: Power down flag
0: After power up or executing the ²CLR WDT² instruction
1: By executing the ²HALT² instruction
OV: Overflow flag
0: no overflow
1: an operation results in a carry into the highest-order bit but not a carry out of the
highest-order bit or vice versa.
Z: Zero flag
0: The result of an arithmetic or logical operation is not zero
1: The result of an arithmetic or logical operation is zero
AC: Auxiliary flag
0: no auxiliary carry
1: an operation results in a carry out of the low nibbles in addition, or no borrow from the
high nibble into the low nibble in subtraction
C: Carry flag
0: no carry-out
1: an operation results in a carry during an addition operation or if a borrow does not take place
during a subtraction operation
C is also affected by a rotate through carry instruction.
27
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
Wake-up Function Register - PAWK
System Clock Configurations
When the microcontroller enters the Idle/Sleep Mode,
various methods exist to wake the device up and continue with normal operation. One method is to allow a
falling edge on the I/O pins to have a wake-up function.
This register is used to select which Port A I/O pins are
used to have this wake-up function.
There are five system oscillators. Three high speed oscillators and two low speed oscillators. The high speed
oscillators are the external crystal/ceramic oscillator HXT, the external - ERC, and the internal RC oscillator HIRC. The two low speed oscillator are the external
32768Hz oscillator - LXT and the internal 32kHz oscillator - LIRC.
Pull-high Registers PAPU, PBPU, PCPU, PDPU, PEPU, PFPU, PGPU
External Crystal/Resonator Oscillator - HXT
The I/O pins, if configured as inputs, can have internal
pull-high resistors connected, which eliminates the need
for external pull-high resistors. This register selects which
I/O pins are connected to internal pull-high resistors.
The simple connection of a crystal across OSC1 and
OSC2 will create the necessary phase shift and feedback for oscillation. However, for some crystals and
most resonator types, to ensure oscillation and accurate
frequency generation, it is necessary to add two small
value external capacitors, C1 and C2. The exact values
of C1 and C2 should be selected in consultation with the
crystal or resonator manufacturer¢s specification.
Software COM Register - SCOMC
The pins PB0~PB3 on Port B can be used as SCOM
lines to drive an external LCD panel. To implement this
function, the SCOMC register is used to setup the correct bias voltages on these pins.
C 1
O S C 1
R f
Oscillator
R
Various oscillator options offer the user a wide range of
functions according to their various application requirements. The flexible features of the oscillator functions
ensure that the best optimisation can be achieved in
terms of speed and power saving. Oscillator selections
and operation are selected through a combination of
configuration options and registers.
C 2
In te r n a l
O s c illa to r
C ir c u it
P 1
T o in te r n a l
c ir c u its
O S C 2
N o te : 1 . R p is n o r m a lly n o t r e q u ir e d . C 1 a n d C 2 a r e r e q u ir e d .
2 . A lth o u g h n o t s h o w n O S C 1 /O S C 2 p in s h a v e a p a r a s itic
c a p a c ita n c e o f a r o u n d 7 p F .
Crystal/Resonator Oscillator - HXT
System Oscillator Overview
In addition to being the source of the main system clock
the oscillators also provide clock sources for the Watchdog Timer and Time Base functions. External oscillators
requiring some external components as well as a two
fully integrated internal oscillators, requiring no external
components, are provided to form a wide range of both
fast and slow system oscillators.
Type
Name
Freq.
Pins
External Crystal
HXT
400kHz~
12MHz
OSC1/
OSC2
External RC
ERC
400kHz~
12MHz
OSC1
HIRC
4, 8 or 12MHz
¾
External Low
Speed Crystal
LXT
32768Hz
XT1/
XT2*
Internal Low
Speed RC
LIRC
32kHz
¾
Internal High
Speed RC
Rev. 1.00
Crystal Oscillator C1 and C2 Values
Crystal Frequency
C1
C2
12MHz
¾
¾
8MHz
¾
¾
4MHz
¾
¾
1MHz
455kHz (see Note 2)
Note:
¾
¾
10pF
10pF
1. C1 and C2 values are for guidance only.
2. XTAL mode configuration option: 455kHz.
3. RP1=5MW~10MW is recommended.
Crystal Recommended Capacitor Values
¾
28
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
External RC Oscillator - ERC
External 32768Hz Crystal Oscillator - LXT
Using the ERC oscillator only requires that a resistor,
with a value between 47kW and 1.5MW, is connected
between OSC1 and VDD, and a capacitor is connected
between OSC and ground, providing a low cost oscillator configuration. It is only the external resistor that determines the oscillation frequency; the external
capacitor has no influence over the frequency and is
connected for stability purposes only. Device trimming
during the manufacturing process and the inclusion of
internal frequency compensation circuits are used to ensure that the influence of the power supply voltage, temperature and process variations on the oscillation
frequency are minimised. As a resistance/frequency reference point, it can be noted that with an external 150kW
resistor connected and with a 5V voltage power supply
and temperature of 25 degrees, the oscillator will have a
frequency of 4MHz within a tolerance of 2%. Here only
the OSC1 pin is used, which is shared with I/O pin PC0,
leaving pin PC1 free for use as a normal I/O pin.
When the microcontroller enters the Idle/Sleep Mode,
the system clock is switched off to stop microcontroller
activity and to conserve power. However, in many
microcontroller applications it may be necessary to keep
the internal timers operational even when the
microcontroller is in the Power-down Mode. To do this,
another clock, independent of the system clock, must be
provided. To do this a configuration option exists to allow
a low speed oscillator, known as the LXT oscillator to be
used. The LXT oscillator is implemented using a
32768Hz crystal connected to pins. However, for some
crystals, to ensure oscillation and accurate frequency
generation, it is necessary to add two small value external capacitors, C1 and C2. The exact values of C1 and
C2 should be selected in consultation with the crystal or
resonator manufacturer¢s specification. The external
parallel feedback resistor, RP2, is required.
V
R
In te r n a l
O s c illa to r
C ir c u it
C 1
D D
3 2 7 6 8 H z
R
In te rn a l R C
O s c illa to r
P 2
O S C
T o in te r n a l
c ir c u its
P C 1 /O S C 1
4 7 0 p F
C 2
N o te : 1 . R p , C 1 a n d C 2 a r e r e q u ir e d .
2 . A lth o u g h n o t s h o w n p in s h a v e a
p a r a s itic c a p a c ita n c e o f a r o u n d 7 p F .
P C 0 /O S C 2
External RC Oscillator - ERC
External LXT Oscillator - HXT
Internal RC Oscillator - HIRC
LXT Oscillator C1 and C2 Values
The internal RC oscillator is a fully integrated system oscillator requiring no external components. The internal
RC oscillator has three fixed frequencies of either
4MHz, 8MHz or 12MHz. Device trimming during the
manufacturing process and the inclusion of internal frequency compensation circuits are used to ensure that
the influence of the power supply voltage, temperature
and process variations on the oscillation frequency are
minimised. As a result, at a power supply of either 3V or
5V and at a temperature of 25 degrees, the fixed oscillation frequency of 4MHz, 8MHz or 12MHz will have a tolerance within 2%. Note that if this internal system clock
option is selected, as it requires no external pins for its
operation, I/O pins PC1 and PC0 are free for use as normal I/O pins.
P C 1 /O S C 2
P C 0 /O S C 1
Crystal Frequency
C1
C2
32768Hz
8pF
10pF
Note:
1. C1 and C2 values are for guidance only.
2. RP2=5M~10MW is recommended.
32768 Hz Crystal Recommended Capacitor Values
For the devices, a configuration option determines if the
XT1/XT2 pins are used for the LXT oscillator or as I/O
pins.
· If the I/O option is selected then the XT1/XT2 pins can
be used as normal I/O pins.
· If the ²LXT oscillator²is selected then the 32768Hz
crystal should be connected to the XT1/ XT2 pins.
In te rn a l R C
O s c illa to r
N o te : P C 0 /P C 1 u s e d a s n o rm a l I/O s
Internal RC Oscillator - HIRC
Rev. 1.00
29
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
LXT Oscillator Low Power Function
Clock Sources
The LXT oscillator can function in one of two modes, the
Quick Start Mode and the Low Power Mode. The mode
selection is executed using the QOSC bit in the RTCC
register.
In discussing the system clocks for the devices, they
can be seen as having a dual clock mode. These dual
clocks are what are known as a High Oscillator and the
other as a Low Oscillator. The High and Low Oscillator
are the system clock sources and can be selected dynamically using the HLCLK bit in the CLKMOD register.
QOSC Bit
LXT Mode
0
Quick Start
1
Low-power
The High Oscillator has the internal name fM whose
source is selected using a configuration option from a
choice of either an external crystal/resonator, external
RC oscillator or external clock source.
After power on the QOSC bit will be automatically
cleared to zero ensuring that the LXT oscillator is in the
Quick Start operating mode. In the Quick Start Mode the
LXT oscillator will power up and stabilise quickly. However, after the LXT oscillator has fully powered up it can
be placed into the Low-power mode by setting the
QOSC bit high. The oscillator will continue to run but
with reduced current consumption, as the higher current
consumption is only required during the LXT oscillator
start-up. In power sensitive applications, such as battery
applications, where power consumption must be kept to
a minimum, it is therefore recommended that the application program sets the QOSC bit high about 2 seconds
after power-on.
The Low Oscillator clock source, has the internal name
fSL, whose source is also selected by configuration option. This internal fSL, fM clock, is further modified by the
SLOWC0~SLOWC2 bits in the CLKMOD register to
provide the low frequency clock source fSLOW.
An additional sub internal clock, with the internal name
fSUB, is a 32kHz clock source which can be sourced from
either LXT or LIRC, selected by configuration option. Together with fSYS/4, it is used as a clock source for certain
internal functions such as the LCD driver, Watchdog
Timer, Buzzer, RTC Interrupt and Time Base Interrupt.
The LCD clock source is the fSUB clock source divided by
8, giving a frequency of 4kHz. The internal clock fS, is
simply a choice of either fSUB or fSYS/4, using a configuration option.
It should be noted that, no matter what condition the
QOSC bit is set to, the LXT oscillator will always function
normally, the only difference is that it will take more time
to start up if in the Low-power mode.
Operating Modes
Internal Low Speed Oscillator - LIRC
After the correct clock source configuration selections
are made, overall operation of the chosen clock is
achieved using the CLKMOD register. A combination of
the HLCLK and IDLEN bits in the CLKMOD register and
use of the HALT instruction determine in which mode the
device will be run. The devices can operate in the following Modes.
When microcontrollers enter a power down condition,
their internal clocks are normally switched off to stop
microcontroller activity and to conserve power. However, in many microcontroller applications it may be necessary to keep some internal functions operational,
such as timers, even when the microcontroller is in the
Power-down mode. To do this, the device has a LIRC
oscillator, which is a fully integrated free running RC oscillator with a typical period of 31.2 s at 5V, requiring no
external components. It is selected via configuration option. When the device enters the Power Down Mode, the
system clock will stop running, however the LIRC oscillator will continue to run if selected to keep various internal functions operational.
· Normal Mode
fM on, fSLOW on, fSYS=fM, CPU on, fS on, fWDT on/off depending upon the WDT configuration option and WDT
control register.
· Slow Mode0
fM off, fSLOW=LXT or LIRC, fSYS=fSLOW, CPU on, fS on,
fWDT on/off depending upon the WDT configuration option and WDT control register.
· Slow Mode1
System Operating Modes
fM on, fSLOW=fM/2~fM/64, fSYS=fSLOW, CPU on, fS on, fWDT
on/off depending upon the WDT configuration option
and WDT control register.
The devices have the ability to operate in several different modes. This range of operating modes, known as
Normal Mode, Slow Mode, Idle Mode and Sleep Mode,
allow the devices to run using a wide range of different
slow and fast clock sources. The devices also possess
the ability to dynamically switch between different clocks
and operating modes. With this choice of operating
functions users are provided with the flexibility to ensure
they obtain optimal performance from the device according to their application specific requirements.
Rev. 1.00
· Idle Mode
fM, fSLOW, fSYS off, CPU off; fSUB on, fS on/off by selecting
fSUB or fSYS/4, fWDT on/off depending upon the WDT
configuration option and WDT control register.
30
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
running. The accompanying tables shows the relationship between the CLKMOD bit, the HALT instruction
and the high/low frequency oscillators. The CLMOD bit
can change normal or Slow Mode.
· Sleep Mode
fM, fSLOW, fSYS, fS, CPU off; fSUB, fWDT on/off depending
upon the WDT configuration option and WDT control
register.
For all devices, when the system enters the Sleep or Idle
Mode, the high frequency system clock will always stop
b 7
S L O W C 2 S L O W C 1 S L O W C 0 S IM ID L E
b 0
L T O
H T O
ID L E N
H L C L K
C L K M O D
R e g is te r
fS Y S s e le c t
1 : fM
0 : fS L O W
Id le m o d e
1 : e n a b le
0 : d is a b le
H ig h o s c illa to r r e a d y fla g
1 : tim e - o u t
0 : n o n - tim e - o u t
L o w o s c illa to r r e a d y fla g
1 : tim e - o u t
0 : n o n - tim e - o u t
S P I/I2 C c o n tin u e s r u n n in g in Id le m o d e
1 :e n a b le
0 :d is a b le
fS L O W s e le c tio n
S L O W W C 2 S L O W W C 1
0
0
0
0
1
0
1
0
0
1
0
1
1
1
1
1
S L O W W C 0
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
fS
L O W
fS
fM
fM
fM
fM
fM
fM
fS
L
L
/6 4
/3 2
/1 6
/8
/4
/2
Clock Control Register - CLKMOD
· Operating Mode Control
Description
Operation Mode
CPU
fSYS
fSUB
NORMAL Mode
On
fM
On
SLOW0 Mode
On
fSL
On
SLOW1 Mode
On
fM/2 ~ fM/64
On
IDLE Mode
Off
Off
On
SLEEP Mode
Off
Off
On/Off
Rev. 1.00
31
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
N o rm a l M o d e
0
" =
E N
L
"ID
&
L T
H A
S e t "H L C L K "
S le e p M o d e
fM O ff,
L X T o r L IR C O n * ,
fS Y S = O ff
H A
L T
w a
ke
-u
&
"ID
O n ,
p
L E
N "
=
S lo w
0
H A
L T
&
"ID
w a
ke
-u
p
L E
N "
=
1
Id le M o d e
R e s e t "H L C L K "
-u p
k e
w a
fM O n ,
L X T o r L IR C
fS Y S = fM
fM O ff,
L X T o r L IR C O n ,
fS Y S = O ff
-u p
k e
w a
M o d e
fM O
L X T o r
fS Y S = fM
o r L X T
" * " D e p e n d s th e W D T e n a b le /d is a b le c o n d itio n .
1
" =
EL N
"ID
&
L T
H A
n /O ff,
L IR C O n ,
/2 ~ fM /6 4
o r L IR C
#
" # " E ith e r th e 3 2 7 6 8 H z o r 3 2 K _ IN T m u s t b e O N .
Dual Clock Mode Operation
H ig h O s c illa to r
E x te rn a l
C lo c k
O S C 1
O S C 1
E x te r n a l C lo c k F ilte r O ff
C o n fig u r a tio n O p tio n
E x te r n a l/X T A L /R C
C o n fig u r a tio n O p tio n
E R C
O S C 2
O S C 1
H X T
O S C 2
fM
M U X
F ilte r
H L C L K B it
fM
fS
O S C 4
L IR C
L o w
O s c illa to r
T C
M U X
fR
C 3 2 K
fS
U B
fS
Y S
M U X
/4
C o n fig u r a tio n
O p tio n
fM /2 , ... fM /6 4 , fS
S L O W C 0
fR
L X T
S L O W C 1
S L O W C 2
O S C 3
fS
S lo w
C lo c k
C o n tro l
L
fS
M U X
fS
Y S
fS
U B
fS
/4
Y S
L O W
L
M U X
T im e r 1
T 1 S
R T C in te r r u p t,
T im e B a s e in te r r u p t,
B u z z e r, W D T
fS C lo c k S e le c t
C o n fig u r a tio n O p tio n
fS
U B
¸ 8
fL
= fS
C D
U B
/8
L C D
Dual Clock Mode Structure
Rev. 1.00
32
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
· The WDT will be cleared and resume counting if the
Mode Switching
WDT clock source is selected to come from the WDT
oscillator. The WDT will stop if its clock source originates from the system clock.
The devices are switched between one mode and another using a combination of the HLCLK bit in the
CLKMOD register and the HALT instruction. The HLCLK
bit chooses whether the system runs in either the Normal or Slow Mode by selecting the system clock to be
sourced from either a high or low frequency oscillator.
The HALT instruction forces the system into either the
Idle or Sleep Mode, depending upon whether the IDLEN
bit in CLKMOD register is set or not.
· The I/O ports will maintain their present condition.
· In the status register, the Power Down flag, PDF, will
be set and the Watchdog time-out flag, TO, will be
cleared.
Standby Current Considerations
As the main reason for entering the Power Down Mode
is to keep the current consumption of the MCU to as low
a value as possible, perhaps only in the order of several
micro-amps, there are other considerations which must
also be taken into account by the circuit designer if the
power consumption is to be minimized. Special attention must be made to the I/O pins on the device. All
high-impedance input pins must be connected to either
a fixed high or low level as any floating input pins could
create internal oscillations and result in increased current consumption. This also applies to devices which
have different package types, as there may be
undonbed pins, which must either be setup as outputs
or if setup as inputs must have pull-high resistors connected. Care must also be taken with the loads, which
are connected to I/O pins, which are setup as outputs.
These should be placed in a condition in which minimum
current is drawn or connected only to external circuits
that do not draw current, such as other CMOS inputs.
Also note that additional standby current will also be required if the configuration options have enabled the
Watchdog Timer internal oscillator.
When a HALT instruction is executed and the IDLEN bit
is not set. The system enters the Sleep mode the following conditions exist:
· The system oscillator will stop running and the appli-
cation program will stop at the ²HALT² instruction.
· The Data Memory contents and registers will maintain
their present condition.
· The WDT will be cleared and resume counting if the
WDT is enabled and clock source is selected from
fSUB. The WDT will stop if its clock source originates
from the system clock or the WDT is disabled.
· The I/O ports will maintain their present condition.
· In the status register, the Power Down flag, PDF, will
be set and the Watchdog time-out flag, TO, will be
cleared.
Power Down Mode and Wake-up
Power Down Mode
All of the Holtek microcontrollers have the ability to enter
a Power Down Mode. When the device enters this
mode, the normal operating current, will be reduced to
an extremely low standby current level. This occurs because when the device enters the Power Down Mode,
the system oscillator is stopped which reduces the
power consumption to extremely low levels, however,
as the device maintains its present internal condition, it
can be woken up at a later stage and continue running,
without requiring a full reset. This feature is extremely
important in application areas where the MCU must
have its power supply constantly maintained to keep the
device in a known condition but where the power supply
capacity is limited such as in battery applications.
Wake-up
After the system enters the Power Down Mode, it can be
woken up from one of various sources listed as follows:
· An external reset
· An external falling edge on Port A
· A system interrupt
· A WDT overflow
If the system is woken up by an external reset, the device will experience a full system reset, however, if the
device is woken up by a WDT overflow, a Watchdog
Timer reset will be initiated. Although both of these
wake-up methods will initiate a reset operation, the actual source of the wake-up can be determined by examining the TO and PDF flags. The PDF flag is cleared by a
system power-up or executing the clear Watchdog
Timer instructions and is set when executing the ²HALT²
instruction. The TO flag is set if a WDT time-out occurs,
and causes a wake-up that only resets the Program
Counter and Stack Pointer, the other flags remain in
their original status.
Entering the Power Down Mode
There is only one way for the device to enter the Power
Down Mode and that is to execute the ²HALT² instruction in the application program. When this instruction is
executed, the following will occur:
· The system oscillator will stop running and the appli-
cation program will stop at the ²HALT² instruction.
· The Data Memory contents and registers will maintain
their present condition.
Rev. 1.00
33
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
Watchdog Timer Operation
Each pin on Port A can be setup via an individual configuration option to permit a negative transition on the pin
The Watchdog Timer clock source is provided by the internal clock, fS, which is in turn supplied by one of two
sources selected by configuration option: fSUB or fSYS/4.
Note that if the Watchdog Timer configuration option
has been disabled, then any instruction relating to its operation will result in no operation.
to wake-up the system. When a Port A pin wake-up occurs, the program will resume execution at the instruction following the ²HALT² instruction.
If the system is woken up by an interrupt, then two possible situations may occur. The first is where the related
interrupt is disabled or the interrupt is enabled but the
stack is full, in which case the program will resume execution at the instruction following the ²HALT² instruction.
In this situation, the interrupt which woke-up the device
will not be immediately serviced, but will rather be serviced later when the related interrupt is finally enabled or
when a stack level becomes free. The other situation is
where the related interrupt is enabled and the stack is
not full, in which case the regular interrupt response
takes place. If an interrupt request flag is set to ²1² before entering the Power Down Mode, the wake-up function of the related interrupt will be disabled.
Most of the Watchdog Timer options, such as enable/disable, Watchdog Timer clock source and clear instruction type are selected using configuration options.
In addition to a configuration option to enable the Watchdog Timer, there are four bits, WDTEN3~ WDTEN0, in
the MISC register to offer an additional enable control of
the Watchdog Timer. These bits must be set to a specific
value of 1010 to disable the Watchdog Timer. Any other
values for these bits will keep the Watchdog Timer enabled. After power on these bits will have the disabled
value of 1010.
One of the WDT clock sources is the internal fSUB, which
can be sourced from either the LXT or LIRC. The LIRC
has an approximate period of 31.2ms at a supply voltage
of 5V. However, it should be noted that this specified internal clock period can vary with VDD, temperature and
process variations. The LXT is supplied by an external
32768Hz crystal. The other Watchdog Timer clock
source option is the fSYS/4 clock. Whether the Watchdog
Timer clock source is LIRC, LXT or fSYS/4, it is divided by
213~216, using configuration option to obtain the required
Watchdog Timer time-out period. The max time out period is when the 216 option is selected. This time-out period may vary with temperature, VDD and process
variations. As the clear instruction only resets the last
stage of the divider chain, for this reason the actual division ratio and corresponding Watchdog Timer time-out
can vary by a factor of two. The exact division ratio depends upon the residual value in the Watchdog Timer
counter before the clear instruction is executed.
No matter what the source of the wake-up event is, once
a wake-up situation occurs, a time period equal to 1024
system clock periods will be required before normal system operation resumes. However, if the wake-up has
originated due to an interrupt, the actual interrupt subroutine execution will be delayed by an additional one or
more cycles. If the wake-up results in the execution of
the next instruction following the ²HALT² instruction, this
will be executed immediately after the 1024 system
clock period delay has ended.
Watchdog Timer
The Watchdog Timer is provided to prevent program
malfunctions or sequences from jumping to unknown locations, due to certain uncontrollable external events
such as electrical noise. It operates by providing a device reset when the Watchdog Timer counter overflows.
C L R W D T 1 F la g
C L R W D T 2 F la g
C o n tro l
L o g ic
1 o r 2 In s tr u c tio n s
fS
Y S
/4
L IR C
L X T
W D T S o u rc e
C o n fig u r a tio n
O p tio n
C L R
fS
8 - b it D iv id e r
fS /2
8
¸
7 - b it P r e s c a le r
2
W D T T im e - o u t
(2 13/fS , 2 14/fS , 2 15/fS o r 2
1 6
/fS )
C o n fig O p tio n
fS /2
1 2
, fS /2
1 3
, fS /2
1 4
o r fS /2
1 5
Watchdog Timer
Rev. 1.00
34
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
Clearing the Watchdog Timer
If the fSYS/4 clock is used as the Watchdog Timer clock
source, it should be noted that when the system enters
the Power Down Mode, then the instruction clock is
stopped and the Watchdog Timer will lose its protecting
purposes. For systems that operate in noisy environments, using the LIRC oscillator is strongly recommended.
There are two methods of using software instructions to
clear the Watchdog Timer, one of which must be chosen
by configuration option. The first option is to use the single ²CLR WDT² instruction while the second is to use the
two commands ²CLR WDT1² and ²CLR WDT2². For the
first option, a simple execution of ²CLR WDT² will clear
the WDT while for the second option, both ²CLR WDT1²
and ²CLR WDT2² must both be executed to successfully
clear the Watchdog Timer. Note that for this second option, if ²CLR WDT1² is used to clear the Watchdog Timer,
successive executions of this instruction will have no effect, only the execution of a ²CLR WDT2² instruction will
clear the Watchdog Timer. Similarly after the ²CLR
WDT2² instruction has been executed, only a successive
²CLR WDT1² instruction can clear the Watchdog Timer.
Under normal program operation, a Watchdog Timer
time-out will initialise a device reset and set the status bit
TO. However, if the system is in the Power Down Mode,
when a Watchdog Timer time-out occurs, the TO bit in
the status register will be set and only the Program
Counter and Stack Pointer will be reset. Three methods
can be adopted to clear the contents of the Watchdog
Timer. The first is an external hardware reset, which
means a low level on the RES pin, the second is using
the watchdog software instructions and the third is via a
²HALT² instruction.
b 7
O D E 3
O D E 2
O D E 1
O D E 0
W D T E N 3
W D T E N 2
W D T E N 1
b 0
W D T E N 0
M IS C
R e g is te r
W a tc h d o g T im e r E n a b le C o n tr o l
W D T E N 3 W D T E N 2 W D T E N 1 W D T E N 0
1
1
0
0
a ll o th e r v a lu e s
d is a b le
e n a b le
P A 0 ~ P A 3 O p e n D r a in C o n tr o l
- d e s c r ib e d e ls e w h e r e
Watchdog Timer Software Control - MISC
Rev. 1.00
35
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
Reset and Initialisation
A reset function is a fundamental part of any
microcontroller ensuring that the device can be set to
some predetermined condition irrespective of outside
parameters. The most important reset condition is after
power is first applied to the microcontroller. In this case,
internal circuitry will ensure that the microcontroller, after a short delay, will be in a well defined state and ready
to execute the first program instruction. After this
power-on reset, certain important internal registers will
be set to defined states before the program commences. One of these registers is the Program Counter,
which will be reset to zero forcing the microcontroller to
begin program execution from the lowest Program
Memory address.
proper reset operation. For this reason it is recommended that an external RC network is connected to
the RES pin, whose additional time delay will ensure
that the RES pin remains low for an extended period
to allow the power supply to stabilise. During this time
delay, normal operation of the microcontroller will be
inhibited. After the RES line reaches a certain voltage
value, the reset delay time tRSTD is invoked to provide
an extra delay time after which the microcontroller will
begin normal operation. The abbreviation SST in the
figures stands for System Start-up Timer.
In addition to the power-on reset, situations may arise
where it is necessary to forcefully apply a reset condition
when the microcontroller is running. One example of this
is where after power has been applied and the
microcontroller is already running, the RES line is forcefully pulled low. In such a case, known as a normal operation reset, some of the microcontroller registers remain
unchanged allowing the microcontroller to proceed with
normal operation after the reset line is allowed to return
high. Another type of reset is when the Watchdog Timer
overflows and resets the microcontroller. All types of reset operations result in different register conditions being setup.
In te rn a l R e s e t
V D D
0 .9 V
R E S
t RR
SS TT DD ++
t SS
SS TT
Note: tRSTD is power-on delay, typical time=100ms
Power-On Reset Timing Chart
For most applications a resistor connected between
VDD and the RES pin and a capacitor connected between VSS and the RES pin will provide a suitable external reset circuit. Any wiring connected to the RES
pin should be kept as short as possible to minimise
any stray noise interference.
For applications that operate within an environment
where more noise is present the Enhanced Reset Circuit shown is recommended.
V
Another reset exists in the form of a Low Voltage Reset,
LVR, where a full reset, similar to the RES reset is implemented in situations where the power supply voltage
falls below a certain threshold.
D D
0 .0 1 m F * *
1 N 4 1 4 8 *
There are five ways in which a microcontroller reset can
occur, through events occurring both internally and externally:
V D D
1 0 k W ~
1 0 0 k W
Reset Functions
3 0 0 W *
R E S /P A 7
0 .1 ~ 1 m F
V S S
· Power-on Reset
The most fundamental and unavoidable reset is the
one that occurs after power is first applied to the
microcontroller. As well as ensuring that the Program
Memory begins execution from the first memory address, a power-on reset also ensures that certain
other registers are preset to known conditions. All the
I/O port and port control registers will power up in a
high condition ensuring that all pins will be first set to
inputs.
Although the microcontroller has an internal RC reset
function, if the VDD power supply rise time is not fast
enough or does not stabilise quickly at power-on, the
internal reset function may be incapable of providing
Rev. 1.00
D D
Note:
²*² It is recommended that this component is
added for added ESD protection
²**² It is recommended that this component is
added in environments where power line noise
is significant
External RES Circuit
More information regarding external reset circuits is
located in Application Note HA0075E on the Holtek
web site.
36
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
· RES Pin Reset
W D T T im e - o u t
This type of reset occurs when the microcontroller is
already running and the RES pin is forcefully pulled
low by external hardware such as an external switch.
In this case as in the case of other reset, the Program
Counter will reset to zero and program execution initiated from this point.
R E S
0 .4 V
0 .9 V
tS
In te rn a l R e s e t
WDT Time-out Reset during Idle/Sleep
Timing Chart
Note:
D D
D D
tR
S T D
+
tS
S T
In te rn a l R e s e t
Note: tRSTD is power-on delay, typical time=100ms
The tSST can be chosen to be either 1024 or 2
clock cycles via configuration option if the system clock source is provided by ERC or HIRC.
The SST is 1024 for HXT or LXT.
Reset Initial Conditions
RES Reset Timing Chart
The different types of reset described affect the reset
flags in different ways. These flags, known as PDF and
TO are located in the status register and are controlled
by various microcontroller operations, such as the
Idle/Sleep function or Watchdog Timer. The reset flags
are shown in the table:
· Low Voltage Reset - LVR
The microcontroller contains a low voltage reset circuit in order to monitor the supply voltage of the device. The LVR function is selected via a configuration
option. If the supply voltage of the device drops to
within a range of 0.9V~VLVR such as might occur when
changing the battery, the LVR will automatically reset
the device internally. For a valid LVR signal, a low supply voltage, i.e., a voltage in the range between
0.9V~VLVR must exist for a time greater than that specified by tLVR in the A.C. characteristics. If the low supply voltage state does not exceed this value, the LVR
will ignore the low supply voltage and will not perform
a reset function. The actual VLVR value can be selected
via configuration options.
TO PDF
S T D
+
tS
RESET Conditions
0
0
Power-on reset
u
u
RES or LVR reset during Normal or Slow
Mode operation
1
u
WDT time-out reset during Normal or Slow
Mode operation
1
1
WDT time-out reset during Idle or Sleep
Mode operation
L V R
tR
S T
Note: ²u² stands for unchanged
S T
In te rn a l R e s e t
The following table indicates the way in which the various components of the microcontroller are affected after
a power-on reset occurs.
Note: tRSTD is power-on delay, typical time=100ms
Low Voltage Reset Timing Chart
Item
· Watchdog Time-out Reset during Normal Operation
Condition After RESET
The Watchdog time-out Reset during normal operation is the same as a hardware RES pin reset except
that the Watchdog time-out flag TO will be set to ²1².
Program Counter
Reset to zero
Interrupts
All interrupts will be disabled
W D T T im e - o u t
WDT
Clear after reset, WDT begins
counting
Timer/Event
Counter
Timer Counter will be turned off
Prescaler
The Timer Counter Prescaler will
be cleared
tR
S T D
+
tS
S T
In te rn a l R e s e t
Note: tRSTD is power-on delay, typical time=100ms
WDT Time-out Reset during Normal Operation
Timing Chart
Input/Output Ports I/O ports will be setup as inputs
Stack Pointer
· Watchdog Time-out Reset during Idle/Sleep mode
Stack Pointer will point to the top
of the stack
The Watchdog time-out Reset during Idle/Sleep mode
is a little different from other kinds of reset. Most of the
conditions remain unchanged except that the Program Counter and the Stack Pointer will be cleared to
²0² and the TO flag will be set to ²1². Refer to the A.C.
Characteristics for tSST details.
Rev. 1.00
37
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
The different kinds of resets all affect the internal registers of the microcontroller in different ways. To ensure reliable
continuation of normal program execution after a reset occurs, it is important to know what condition the microcontroller
is in after a particular reset occurs. The following table describes how each type of reset affects each of the
microcontroller internal registers.
HT56R26
HT56R25
HT56R24
HT56R23
HT56R22
Register
Power-on
Reset
RES or LVR
Reset
WDT Time-out
(Normal Operation)
WDT Time-out
(Idle/Sleep)
MP0
·
-xxx xxxx
-uuu uuuu
-uuu uuuu
-uuu uuuu
MP1
·
-xxx xxxx
-uuu uuuu
-uuu uuuu
-uuu uuuu
MP0
·
·
·
·
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
MP1
·
·
·
·
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
---- --00
---- --00
---- --00
---- --uu
---- - 000
---- - 000
---- - 000
---- - uuu
--00 0000
--00 0000
--00 0000
--uu uuuu
·
-000 0000
-000 0000
-000 0000
-uuu uuuu
·
·
·
BP
·
ACC
·
·
·
·
·
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
PCL
·
·
·
·
·
0000 0000
0000 0000
0000 0000
0000 0000
TBLP
·
·
·
·
·
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
·
·
TBLH
--xx xxxx
--uu uuuu
--uu uuuu
--uu uuuu
-xxx xxxx
-uuu uuuu
-uuu uuuu
-uuu uuuu
·
·
·
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
RTCC
·
·
·
·
·
--00 0111
--00 0111
--00 0111
--uu uuuu
STATUS
·
·
·
·
·
--00 xxxx
--uu uuuu
--1u uuuu
--11 uuuu
INTC0
·
·
·
·
·
-000 0000
-000 0000
-000 0000
-uuu uuuu
LCDC
·
·
·
·
·
--00 0000
--00 0000
--00 0000
--uu uuuu
TMR0
·
·
·
·
·
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
TMR0C
·
·
·
·
·
00-0 1000
00-0 1000
00-0 1000
uu-u uuuu
TMR1
·
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
·
00-0 1000
00-0 1000
00-0 1000
uu-u uuuu
TMR1C
·
·
·
·
0000 1---
0000 1---
0000 1---
uuuu u---
TMR1L
·
·
·
·
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
TMR1H
·
·
·
·
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
TMR2
·
·
·
·
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
TMR2C
·
·
·
·
00-0 1000
00-0 1000
00-0 1000
uu-u uuuu
TMR3
·
·
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
TMR3C
·
·
00-0 1000
00-0 1000
00-0 1000
uu-u uuuu
PA
·
·
·
·
·
1111 1111
1111 1111
1111 1111
uuuu uuuu
PAC
·
·
·
·
·
1111 1111
1111 1111
1111 1111
uuuu uuuu
PAWK
·
·
·
·
·
0000 0000
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
PAPU
·
·
·
·
·
0000 0000
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
Rev. 1.00
38
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
PCC
PCPU
PD
PDC
PDPU
HT56R26
PC
HT56R25
PBPU
HT56R24
PBC
HT56R23
PB
HT56R22
Register
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
Power-on
Reset
RES or LVR
Reset
WDT Time-out
(Normal Operation)
WDT Time-out
(Idle/Sleep)
--11 1111
--11 1111
--11 1111
--uu uuuu
1111 1111
1111 1111
1111 1111
uuuu uuuu
--11 1111
--11 1111
--11 1111
--uu uuuu
1111 1111
1111 1111
1111 1111
uuuu uuuu
--00 0000
--00 0000
--00 0000
--uu uuuu
0000 0000
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
1--- 1111
1--- 1111
1--- 1111
u--- uuuu
1111 1111
1111 1111
uuuu uuuu
·
·
·
·
1111 1111
1--- 1111
1--- 1111
1--- 1111
u--- uuuu
·
·
·
·
1111 1111
1111 1111
1111 1111
uuuu uuuu
---- 0000
---- 0000
---- 0000
---- uuuu
0000 0000
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
---- -111
---- -111
---- -111
---- -uuu
1111 1111
1111 1111
1111 1111
uuuu uuuu
---- -111
---- -111
---- -111
---- -uuu
1111 1111
1111 1111
1111 1111
uuuu uuuu
---- -000
---- -000
---- -000
---- -uuu
0000 0000
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
PWM0L
·
·
·
·
·
0000 ---0
0000 ---0
0000 ---0
uuuu ---u
PWM0H
·
·
·
·
·
0000 0000
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
PWM1L
·
·
·
·
·
0000 ---0
0000 ---0
0000 ---0
uuuu ---u
PWM1H
·
·
·
·
·
0000 0000
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
·
·
---0 ---0
---0 ---0
---0 ---0
---u ---u
--00 --00
--00 --00
--00 --00
--uu --uu
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
-000 -000
-000 -000
-000 -000
-uuu -uuu
ADPCR
·
·
·
·
·
0000 0000
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
PWM2L
·
·
·
·
·
0000 ---0
0000 ---0
0000 ---0
uuuu ---u
PWM2H
·
·
·
·
·
0000 0000
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
PWM3L
·
·
·
·
0000 ---0
0000 ---0
0000 ---0
uuuu ---u
PWM3H
·
·
·
·
0000 0000
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
INTC1
ADRL
·
·
·
·
·
xxxx ----
xxxx ----
xxxx ----
uuuu ----
ADRH
·
·
·
·
·
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
ADCR
·
·
·
·
·
01-- -000
01-- -000
01-- -000
uuu- --uu
ACSR
·
·
·
·
·
11-- -000
11-- -000
11-- -000
uu-- -uuu
CLKMOD
·
·
·
·
·
0000 0x11
0000 0x11
0000 0x11
uuuu uuuu
INTEDGE
·
·
·
·
·
---- 0000
---- 0000
---- 0000
---- uuuu
SPICTL0
·
·
·
·
·
111- --0-
111- --0-
111- --0-
uuu- --u-
Rev. 1.00
39
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
HT56R22
HT56R23
HT56R24
HT56R25
HT56R26
Power-on
Reset
SPICTL1
·
·
·
·
·
--00 0000
--00 0000
--00 0000
--uu uuuu
SPIDR
·
·
·
·
·
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
DACTRL
·
·
·
·
·
xxx- ---0
xxx- ---0
xxx- ---0
uuu- ---u
MISC
·
·
·
·
·
0000 1010
0000 1010
0000 1010
uuuu uuuu
MFIC0
·
·
·
·
·
0000 0000
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
---0 ---0
---0 ---0
---0 ---0
---u ---u
--00 --00
--00 --00
--00 --00
--uu --uu
-000 -000
-000 -000
-000 -000
-uuu -uuu
Register
·
·
MFIC1
·
RES or LVR
Reset
WDT Time-out
(Normal Operation)
WDT Time-out
(Idle/Sleep)
·
·
·
·
·
1110 000-
1110 000-
1110 000-
uuuu uuu-
·
·
·
1000 0001
1000 0001
1000 0001
uuuu uuuu
·
·
·
·
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
·
·
·
·
0000 0000
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
TMR2
·
·
·
·
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
uu-u uuuu
TMR2C
·
·
·
·
00-0 1000
00-0 1000
00-0 1000
uuuu uuuu
·
·
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
uu-u uuuu
·
00-0 1000
00-0 1000
00-0 1000
uuuu uuuu
SIMCTRL0
·
·
SIMCTRL1
·
·
SIMDR
·
SIMAR/
SIMCTL2
·
TMR3
TMR3C
DAL
·
·
·
·
·
0000 ----
0000 ----
0000 ----
uuuu ----
DAH
·
·
·
·
·
0000 0000
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
·
·
--11 1111
--11 1111
--11 1111
--uu uuuu
1111 1111
1111 1111
1111 1111
uuuu uuuu
--11 1111
--11 1111
--11 1111
--uu uuuu
1111 1111
1111 1111
uuuu uuuu
PE
·
·
PEC
·
PEPU
·
PF
·
·
·
1111 1111
--00 0000
--00 0000
--00 0000
--uu uuuu
·
·
0000 0000
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
---- 1111
---- 1111
---- 1111
---- uuuu
1111 1111
1111 1111
1111 1111
uuuu uuuu
---- 1111
---- 1111
---- 1111
---- uuuu
1111 1111
1111 1111
1111 1111
uuuu uuuu
---- 0000
---- 0000
---- 0000
---- uuuu
·
·
·
·
PFC
·
·
·
·
PFPU
·
·
·
·
·
0000 0000
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
PG
·
·
---- --11
---- --11
---- --11
---- --uu
PGC
·
·
---- --11
---- --11
---- --11
---- --uu
PGPU
·
·
---- --00
---- --00
---- --00
---- --uu
·
·
0000 0000
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
PINMAP
Note:
·
·
²-² not implemented
²u² means ²unchanged²
²x² means ²unknown²
Rev. 1.00
40
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
Port A Wake-up
Input/Output Ports
If the HALT instruction is executed, the device will enter
the Idle/Sleep Mode, where the system clock will stop
resulting in power being conserved, a feature that is important for battery and other low-power applications.
Various methods exist to wake-up the microcontroller,
one of which is to change the logic condition on one of
the PA0~PA7 pins from high to low. After a HALT instruction forces the microcontroller into entering the
Idle/Sleep Mode, the processor will remain idle or in a
low-power state until the logic condition of the selected
wake-up pin on Port A changes from high to low. This
function is especially suitable for applications that can
be woken up via external switches. Note that pins PA0 to
PA7 can be selected individually to have this wake-up
feature using an internal register known as PAWK, located in the Data Memory.
Holtek microcontrollers offer considerable flexibility on
their I/O ports. Most pins can have either an input or output designation under user program control. Additionally, as there are pull-high resistors and wake-up
software configurations, the user is provided with an I/O
structure to meet the needs of a wide range of application possibilities.
For input operation, these ports are non-latching, which
means the inputs must be ready at the T2 rising edge of
instruction ²MOV A,[m]², where m denotes the port address. For output operation, all the data is latched and
remains unchanged until the output latch is rewritten.
Pull-high Resistors
Many product applications require pull-high resistors for
their switch inputs usually requiring the use of an external
resistor. To eliminate the need for these external resistors, when configured as an input have the capability of
being connected to an internal pull-high resistor. These
pull-high resistors are selectable via a register known as
PAPU, PBPU, PCPU, PDPU, PEPU, PFPU and PGPU
located in the Data Memory. The pull-high resistors are
implemented using weak PMOS transistors. Note that pin
PC7 does not have a pull-high resistor selection.
· PAWK, PAC, PAPU, PBC, PBPU, PCC, PCPU, PDC, PDPU Register
¨
HT56R22
Bit
Register
Name
POR
PAWK
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
00H
PAWK7
PAWK6
PAWK5
PAWK4
PAWK3
PAWK2
PAWK1
PAWK0
PAC
FFH
PAC7
PAC6
PAC5
PAC4
PAC3
PAC2
PAC1
PAC0
PAPU
00H
PAPU7
PAPU6
PAPU5
PAPU4
PAPU3
PAPU2
PAPU1
PAPU0
PBC
3FH
¾
¾
PBC5
PBC4
PBC3
PBC2
PBC1
PBC0
PBPU
00H
¾
¾
PBPU5
PBPU4
PBPU3
PBPU2
PBPU1
PBPU0
PCC
8FH
PCC7
¾
¾
¾
PCC3
PCC2
PCC1
PCC0
PCPU
00H
¾
¾
¾
¾
PCPU3
PCPU2
PCPU1
PCPU0
PDC
07H
¾
¾
¾
¾
¾
PDC2
PDC1
PDC0
PDPU
00H
¾
¾
¾
¾
¾
PDPU2
PDPU1
PDPU0
²¾² Unimplemented, read as ²0²
PAWKn: PA wake-up function enable
0: disable
1: enable
PACn/PBCn/PCCn/PDCn: I/O type selection
0: output
1: input
PAPUn/PBPUn/PCPUn/PDPUn: Pull-high function enable
0: disable
1: enable
Rev. 1.00
41
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
· PAWK, PAC, PAPU, PBC, PBPU, PCC, PCPU, PDC, PDPU, PEC, PEPU, PFC, PFPU
¨
HT56R23/HT56R24
Bit
Register
Name
POR
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
PAWK
00H
PAWK7
PAWK6
PAWK5
PAWK4
PAWK3
PAWK2
PAWK1
PAWK0
PAC
FFH
PAC7
PAC6
PAC5
PAC4
PAC3
PAC2
PAC1
PAC0
PAPU
00H
PAPU\7
PAPU6
PAPU5
PAPU4
PAPU3
PAPU2
PAPU1
PAPU0
PBC
FFH
PBC7
PBC6
PBC5
PBC4
PBC3
PBC2
PBC1
PBC0
PBPU
00H
PBPU7
PBPU6
PBPU5
PBPU4
PBPU3
PBPU2
PBPU1
PBPU0
PCC
FFH
PCC7
PCC6
PCC5
PCC4
PCC3
PCC2
PCC1
PCC0
PCPU
00H
¾
PCPU6
PCPU5
PCPU4
PCPU3
PCPU2
PCPU1
PCPU0
PDC
FFH
PDC7
PDC6
PDC5
PDC4
PDC3
PDC2
PDC1
PDC0
PDPU
00H
PDPU7
PDPU6
PDPU5
PDPU4
PDPU3
PDPU2
PDPU1
PDPU0
PEC
3FH
¾
¾
PEC5
PEC4
PEC3
PEC2
PEC1
PEC0
PEPU
00H
¾
¾
PEPU5
PEPU4
PEPU3
PEPU2
PEPU1
PEPU0
PFC
0FH
¾
¾
¾
¾
PFC3
PFC2
PFC1
PFC0
PFPU
00H
¾
¾
¾
¾
PFPU3
PFPU2
PFPU1
PFPU0
²¾² Unimplemented, read as ²0²
PAWKn: PA wake-up function enable
0: disable
1: enable
PACn/PBCn/PCCn/PDCn/PECn/PFCn: I/O type selection
0: output
1: input
PAPUn/PBPUn/PCPUn/PDPUn/PEPUn/PFPUn: Pull-high function enable
0: disable
1: enable
Rev. 1.00
42
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
· PAWK, PAC, PAPU, PBC, PBPU, PCC, PCPU, PDC, PDPU, PEC, PEPU, PFC, PFPU, PGC, PGPU
¨
HT56R25/HT56R26
Bit
Register
Name
POR
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
PAWK
00H
PAWK7
PAWK6
PAWK5
PAWK4
PAWK3
PAWK2
PAWK1
PAWK0
PAC
FFH
PAC7
PAC6
PAC5
PAC4
PAC3
PAC2
PAC1
PAC0
PAPU
00H
PAPU\7
PAPU6
PAPU5
PAPU4
PAPU3
PAPU2
PAPU1
PAPU0
PBC
FFH
PBC7
PBC6
PBC5
PBC4
PBC3
PBC2
PBC1
PBC0
PBPU
00H
PBPU7
PBPU6
PBPU5
PBPU4
PBPU3
PBPU2
PBPU1
PBPU0
PCC
FFH
PCC7
PCC6
PCC5
PCC4
PCC3
PCC2
PCC1
PCC0
PCPU
00H
¾
PCPU6
PCPU5
PCPU4
PCPU3
PCPU2
PCPU1
PCPU0
PDC
FFH
PDC7
PDC6
PDC5
PDC4
PDC3
PDC2
PDC1
PDC0
PDPU
00H
PDPU7
PDPU6
PDPU5
PDPU4
PDPU3
PDPU2
PDPU1
PDPU0
PEC
FFH
PEC7
PEC6
PEC5
PEC4
PEC3
PEC2
PEC1
PEC0
PEPU
00H
PEPU7
PEPU6
PEPU5
PEPU4
PEPU3
PEPU2
PEPU1
PEPU0
PFC
FFH
PFC7
PFC6
PFC5
PFC4
PFC3
PFC2
PFC1
PFC0
PFPU
00H
PFPU7
PFPU6
PFPU5
PFPU4
PFPU3
PFPU2
PFPU1
PFPU0
PGC
03H
¾
¾
¾
¾
¾
¾
PGC1
PGC0
PGPU
00H
¾
¾
¾
¾
¾
¾
PGPU1
PGPU0
²¾² Unimplemented, read as ²0²
PAWKn: PA wake-up function enable
0: disable
1: enable
PACn/PBCn/PCCn/PDCn/PECn/PFCn/PGCn: I/O type selection
0: output
1: input
PAPUn/PBPUn/PCPUn/PDPUn/PEPUn/PFPUn/PGPUn: Pull-high function enable
0: disable
1: enable
Rev. 1.00
43
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
output to enable the PFD output. If the port control
register has setup the pin as an input, then the pin will
function as a normal logic input with the usual
pull-high selection, even if the PFD function has been
selected.
I/O Port Control Registers
Each Port has its own control register, known as PAC,
PBC, PCC, PDC, PEC, PFC and PGC which controls
the input/output configuration. With this control register,
each I/O pin with or without pull-high resistors can be reconfigured dynamically under software control. For the
I/O pin to function as an input, the corresponding bit of
the control register must be written as a ²1². This will
then allow the logic state of the input pin to be directly
read by instructions. When the corresponding bit of the
control register is written as a ²0², the I/O pin will be
setup as a CMOS output. If the pin is currently setup as
an output, instructions can still be used to read the output register. However, it should be noted that the program will in fact only read the status of the output data
latch and not the actual logic status of the output pin.
· PWM Outputs
The PWM function whose outputs are pin-shared with
I/O pins. The PWM output functions are chosen using
the PWMnL and PWMnH (n=0~3) registers. Note that
the corresponding bit of the port control registers, for
the output pin, must setup the pin as an output to enable the PWM output. If the pins are setup as inputs,
then the pin will function as a normal logic input with
the usual pull-high selections, even if the PWM registers have enabled the PWM function.
· SCOM Driver Pins
Pins PB0~PB3 on Port B can be used as LCD COM
driver pins. This function is controlled using the
SCOMC register which will generate the necessary
1/2 bias signals on these four pins.
Pin-shared Functions
The flexibility of the microcontroller range is greatly enhanced by the use of pins that have more than one function. Limited numbers of pins can force serious design
constraints on designers but by supplying pins with
multi-functions, many of these difficulties can be overcome. For some pins, the chosen function of the
multi-function I/O pins is set by configuration options
while for others the function is set by application program control.
· A/D Inputs
Each device in this series has eight inputs to the A/D
converter. All of these analog inputs are pin-shared
with I/O pins. If these pins are to be used as A/D inputs
and not as I/O pins then the corresponding PCRn bits
in the A/D converter control register, ADPCR, must be
properly setup. There are no configuration options associated with the A/D converter. If chosen as I/O pins,
then full pull-high resistor configuration options remain, however if used as A/D inputs then any pull-high
resistor configuration options associated with these
pins will be automatically disconnected.
· External Interrupt Input
The external interrupt pin, INT0/INT1, are pin-shared
with an I/O pins. To use the pins as external interrupt
inputs the correct bits in the INTC0 register must be
programmed. The pin must also be setup as an input
by setting bit in the Port Control Register. A pull-high
resistor can also be selected via the appropriate port
pull-high resistor register. Note that even if the pin is
setup as an external interrupt input the I/O function
still remains.
Pin Remapping Configuration
The pin remapping function enables the function pins
INT0/1, TC0/1, PFD, PWM0/1/2 to be located on different port pins. It is important not to confuse the Pin Remapping function with the Pin-shared function, these
two functions have no interdependence.
· External Timer/Event Counter Input
The PMAP0~7 bit in the PINMAP register allows the
three function pins INT0/1, TC0/1, PFD, PWM0/1/2 to
be remapped to different port pins. After power up,
these bits will be reset to zero, which will define the default port pins to which these three functions will be
mapped. Changing this bit will move the functions to
other port pins.
The Timer/Event Counter pins, TC0, TC1, TC2 and
TC3 are pin-shared with I/O pins. For these shared
pins to be used as Timer/Event Counter inputs, the
Timer/Event Counter must be configured to be in the
Event Counter or Pulse Width Capture Mode. This is
achieved by setting the appropriate bits in the
Timer/Event Counter Control Register. The pins must
also be setup as inputs by setting the appropriate bit
in the Port Control Register. Pull-high resistor options
can also be selected using the port pull-high resistor
registers. Note that even if the pin is setup as an external timer input the I/O function still remains.
Examination of the pin names on the package diagrams
will reveal that some pin function names are repeated,
this indicates a function pin that can be remapped to
other port pins. If the pin name is bracketed then this indicates its alternative location. Pin names without brackets indicates its default location which is the condition
after Power-on.
· PFD Output
The PFD function output is pin-shared with an I/O pin.
The output function of this pin is chosen using the
Configuration option. Note that the corresponding bit
of the port control register, must setup the pin as an
Rev. 1.00
44
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
· HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
Register
Name
PINMAP
Bit
POR
00H
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
PMAP7
PMAP6
PMAP5
PMAP4
PMAP3
PMAP2
PMAP1
PMAP0
0: PD2/PWM2
0 : PD1/PWM1
0: PD0/PWM0
1: PE5/[PWM2] 1: PD5/[PWM1] 1: PD4/[PWM0]
0: PA7/TC1
0: PA6/INT1
0: PA5/TC0
0: PA4/INT0
0: PA3/PFD
1: PD6/[TC1]
1: PD7/[INT1]
1: PE2/[TC0]
1: PE1/[INT0]
1: PE0/[PFD]
PINMAP Register
V
P u ll- H ig h
S e le c t
C o n tr o l B it
D a ta B u s
Q
D
W r ite C o n tr o l R e g is te r
W e a k
P u ll- u p
Q
C K
S
C h ip R e s e t
I/O
R e a d C o n tr o l R e g is te r
p in
D a ta B it
Q
D
W r ite D a ta R e g is te r
C K
Q
S
M
R e a d D a ta R e g is te r
S y s te m
D D
U
X
P A o n ly
W a k e -u p
W a k e - u p S e le c t
Generic Input/Output Ports
C o n tr o l B it
Q
D
D a ta B u s
W r ite C o n tr o l R e g is te r
C K
Q
S
C h ip R e s e t
P C 7 /R E S
R e a d C o n tr o l R e g is te r
D a ta B it
Q
D
W r ite D a ta R e g is te r
C K
S
Q
M
R e a d D a ta R e g is te r
U
X
R E S fo r P C 7 o n ly
PC7 NMOS Input/Output Port
Rev. 1.00
45
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
V
P u ll- H ig h
S e le c t
C o n tr o l B it
Q
D
D a ta B u s
W r ite C o n tr o l R e g is te r
D D
W e a k
P u ll- u p
Q
C K
S
C h ip R e s e t
R e a d C o n tr o l R e g is te r
P B 0 /S C O M 0 ~
P B 3 /S C O M 3
D a ta B it
Q
D
W r ite D a ta R e g is te r
Q
C K
S
M
R e a d D a ta R e g is te r
U
X
V
D D
/2
C O M n E N
S C O M E N
PB Input/Output Port
I/O Pin Structures
The diagrams illustrate the I/O pin internal structures. As
the exact logical construction of the I/O pin may differ
from these drawings, they are supplied as a guide only
to assist with the functional understanding of the I/O
pins.
Pins PA0 to PA7 each have a wake-up functions, selected via the PAWK register. When the device is in the
Idle/Sleep Mode, various methods are available to wake
the device up. One of these is a high to low transition of
any of the these pins. Single or multiple pins on Port A
can be setup to have this function.
Programming Considerations
Timer/Event Counters
Within the user program, one of the first things to consider is port initialisation. After a reset, the I/O data register and I/O port control register will be set high. This
means that all I/O pins will default to an input state, the
level of which depends on the other connected circuitry
and whether pull-high options have been selected. If the
port control registers, are then programmed to setup
some pins as outputs, these output pins will have an initial high output value unless the associated port data
register is first programmed. Selecting which pins are inputs and which are outputs can be achieved byte-wide
by loading the correct value into the port control register
or by programming individual bits in the port control register using the ²SET [m].i² and ²CLR [m].i² instructions.
Note that when using these bit control instructions, a
read-modify-write operation takes place. The
microcontroller must first read in the data on the entire
port, modify it to the required new bit values and then rewrite this data back to the output ports.
The provision of timers form an important part of any
microcontroller, giving the designer a means of carrying
out time related functions. The devices contain several
8-bit and 16-bit count-up timers. As each timer has three
different operating modes, they can be configured to operate as a general timer, an external event counter or as
a pulse width measurement device. The provision of a
prescaler to the clock circuitry of the 8-bit Timer/Event
Counter also gives added range to this timer.
T 1
S y s te m
T 2
T 3
T 4
T 1
T 2
T 3
There are two types of registers related to the
Timer/Event Counters. The first are the registers that
contain the actual value of the Timer/Event Counter and
into which an initial value can be preloaded. Reading
from these registers retrieves the contents of the
Timer/Event Counter. The second type of associated
register is the Timer Control Register which defines the
timer options and determines how the Timer/Event
Counter is to be used. The Timer/Event Counters can
have the their clock configured to come from an internal
clock source. In addition, their clock source can also be
configured to come from an external timer pin.
T 4
C lo c k
P o rt D a ta
R e a d fro m
P o rt
W r ite to P o r t
Read Modify Write Timing
Rev. 1.00
46
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
Configuring the Timer/Event Counter Input Clock
Source
value in the timer registers increases by one each time an
internal clock pulse is received or an external transition occurs on the external timer pin. The timer will count from the
initial value loaded by the preload register to the full count
of FFH for the 8-bit timer or FFFFH for the 16-bit timer at
which point the timer overflows and an internal interrupt
signal is generated. The timer value will then be reset with
the initial preload register value and continue counting.
The internal timer¢s clock can originate from various
sources. The system clock source is used when the
Timer/Event Counter is in the timer mode or in the pulse
width measurement mode. For the 8-bit Timer/Event
Counter this internal clock source is fSYS which is also divided by a prescaler, the division ratio of which is conditioned by the Timer Control Register, TMRnC, bits
TnPSC0~TnPSC2. For the 16-bit Timer/Event Counter
this internal clock source can be chosen from a combination of internal clocks using a configuration option and
the TnS bit in the TMRnC register.
To achieve a maximum full range count of FFH for the
8-bit timer or FFFFH for the 16-bit timer, the preload registers must first be cleared to all zeros. It should be
noted that after power-on, the preload register will be in
an unknown condition. Note that if the Timer/Event
Counter is switched off and data is written to its preload
registers, this data will be immediately written into the
actual timer registers. However, if the Timer/Event
Counter is enabled and counting, any new data written
into the preload data registers during this period will remain in the preload registers and will only be written into
the timer registers the next time an overflow occurs.
An external clock source is used when the timer is in the
event counting mode, the clock source being provided
on an external timer pin TMR0, TMR1, TMR2 or TMR3
depending upon which timer is used. Depending upon
the condition of the TnE bit, each high to low, or low to
high transition on the external timer pin will increment
the counter by one.
Device
No. of 8-bit Timers
Timer Name
Timer Register Name
Control Register Name
No. of 16-bit Timers
Timer Name
Timer Register Name
Control Register Name
For the 16-bit Timer/Event Counter which has both low
byte and high byte timer registers, accessing these registers is carried out in a specific way. It must be noted
when using instructions to preload data into the low byte
timer register, the data will only be placed in a low byte
buffer and not directly into the low byte timer register.
The actual transfer of the data into the low byte timer
register is only carried out when a write to its associated
high byte timer register, namely TMR1H, is executed.
On the other hand, using instructions to preload data
into the high byte timer register will result in the data being directly written to the high byte timer register. At the
same time the data in the low byte buffer will be transferred into its associated low byte timer register. For this
reason, the low byte timer register should be written first
when preloading data into the 16-bit timer registers. It
must also be noted that to read the contents of the low
byte timer register, a read to the high byte timer register
must be executed first to latch the contents of the low
byte timer register into its associated low byte buffer. After this has been done, the low byte timer register can be
read in the normal way. Note that reading the low byte
timer register will result in reading the previously latched
contents of the low byte buffer and not the actual contents of the low byte timer register.
All Devices
3
Timer/Event Counter 0
Timer/Event Counter 2
Timer/Event Counter 3
TMR0
TMR2
TMR3
TMR0C
TMR2C
TMR3C
1
Timer/Event Counter 1
TMR1L/TMR1H
TMR1C
Timer Registers - TMR0, TMR1L/TMR1H,
TMR2, TMR3
The timer registers are special function registers located in
the Special Purpose Data Memory and is the place where
the actual timer value is stored. For the 8-bit Timer/Event
Counters, these registers are known as TMR0, TMR2 or
TMR3. For the 16-bit Timer/Event Counter, a pair of registers are required and are known as TMR1L/TMR1H. The
Rev. 1.00
47
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
D a ta B u s
R e lo a d
P r e lo a d R e g is te r
T n P S C 2 ~ T n P S C 0
(1 /1 ~ 1 /1 2 8 )
fS
7 - s ta g e P r e s c a le r
Y S
T n M 1
T n M 0
F ilte r
T M R n
T im e r /E v e n t
C o u n te r
T im e r /E v e n t C o u n te r
M o d e C o n tro l
8 - b it T im e r /E v e n t C o u n te r
T n O N
F ilte r O n /O ff
C o n fig u r a tio n o p tio n
O v e r flo w
to In te rru p t
¸ 2
P F D 0
T n E
8-bit Timer/Event Counter Structure
D a ta B u s
L o w B y te
B u ffe r
E x te rn a l 3 2 7 6 8 H z
M
In te rn a l 3 2 K -IN T
U
fS
fS
X
Y S
M
/4
U B
U
X
H ig h B y te
F ilte r O n /O ff
C o n fig u r a tio n o p tio n
L o w
R e lo a d
O v e r flo w
to In te rru p t
B y te
1 6 - b it T im e r /E v e n t C o u n te r
T n O N
F ilte r
T M R n
1 6 - B it
P r e lo a d R e g is te r
T n M 0
T im e r /E v e n t C o u n te r
M o d e C o n tro l
T n S
C o n fig u r a tio n
O p tio n
T n M 1
¸ 2
P F D 1
T n E
16-bit Timer/Event Counter Structure
M
P F D 0
P F D 1
U
X
P F D
C o n fig u r a tio n
O p tio n
b 7
T n M 1 T n M 0
b 0
T n O N
T n E
T n P S C 2
T n P S C 1
T n P S C 0
T M R n C
R e g is te r (n = 0 , 2 , 3 )
T im e r p r e s c a le r r a te s e le
T n P
T n P S C 2 T n P S C 1
0
0
0
0
0
1
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
1
1
1
E v e n t C
1 : c o u n
0 : c o u n
P u ls e W
1 : s ta rt
0 : s ta rt
o u n te r a c tiv e e d g
t o n fa llin g e d g e
t o n r is in g e d g e
id th M e a s u r e m e n
c o u n tin g o n r is in g
c o u n tin g o n fa llin g
0
c t
S C 0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
T im e r
1 :1
1 :2
1 :4
1 :8
1 :1
1 :3
1 :6
1 :1
R a te
6
4
2
2 8
e s e le c t
t a c tiv e e d g e s e le c t
e d g e , s to p o n fa llin g e d g e
e d g e , s to p o n r is in g e d g e
T im e r /E v e n t C o u n te r c o u n tin g e n a b le
1 : e n a b le
0 : d is a b le
N o t im p le m e n te d , r e a d a s " 0 "
O p e r a tin
T n M 1 T
0
0
1
1
g m o d e
n M 0
n o
0
e v
1
tim
0
p u
1
s e le c t
m o d
e n t c
e r m
ls e w
e a v a ila b le
o u n te r m o d e
o d e
id th m e a s u r e m e n t m o d e
Timer/Event Counter Control Register - TMRnC
Rev. 1.00
48
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
b 7
T n M 1
b 0
T n M 0
T n S
T n O N
T n E
T M R n C
R e g is te r (n = 1 )
N o t im p le m e n te d , r e a d a s " 0 "
E v
1 :
0 :
P u
1 :
0 :
e n t C
c o u n
c o u n
ls e W
s ta rt
s ta rt
o u n
t o n
t o n
id th
c o u n
c o u n
te r a c tiv e e d g
fa llin g e d g e
r is in g e d g e
M e a s u re m e n
tin g o n r is in g
tin g o n fa llin g
e s e le c t
t a c tiv e e d g e s e le c t
e d g e , s to p o n fa llin g e d g e
e d g e , s to p o n r is in g e d g e
T im e r /E v e n t C o u n te r c o u n tin g e n a b le
1 : e n a b le
0 : d is a b le
T im e r c lo c k s o u r c e
1 : fS U B (3 2 7 6 8 H z o r 3 2 K R C )
0 : fS Y S /4
O p e r a tin g m o d e
T n M 1 T n M 0
n o
0
0
e v
0
1
1
tim
0
1
1
p u
s e le c t
m o d
e n t c
e r m
ls e w
e a v a ila b le
o u n te r m o d e
o d e
id th m e a s u r e m e n t m o d e
Timer/Event Counter Control Register - TMRnC
Timer Control Registers TMR0C, TMR1C, TMR2C, TMR3C
known as the bit pair TnM1/TnM0, must be set to the required logic levels. The timer-on bit, which is bit 4 of the
Timer Control Register and known as TnON, depending
upon which timer is used, provides the basic on/off control of the respective timer. Setting the bit high allows the
counter to run, clearing the bit stops the counter. For
timers that have prescalers, bits 0~2 of the Timer Control Register determine the division ratio of the input
clock prescaler. The prescaler bit settings have no effect
if an external clock source is used. If the timer is in the
event count or pulse width measurement mode, the active transition edge level type is selected by the logic
level of bit 3 of the Timer Control Register which is
known as TnE. An additional T1S bit in the 16-bit
Timer/Event Counter control register is used to determine the clock source for the Timer/Event Counter.
The flexible features of the Holtek microcontroller
Timer/Event Counters enable them to operate in three
different modes, the options of which are determined by
the contents of their respective control register.
It is the Timer Control Register together with its corresponding timer registers that control the full operation of
the Timer/Event Counters. Before the timers can be
used, it is essential that the appropriate Timer Control
Register is fully programmed with the right data to ensure its correct operation, a process that is normally carried out during program initialisation.
To choose which of the three modes the timer is to operate in, either in the timer mode, the event counting mode
or the pulse width measurement mode, bits 7 and 6 of
the corresponding Timer Control Register, which are
Rev. 1.00
49
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
· TMR0C Register
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Name
T0M1
T0M0
¾
T0ON
T0EG
T0PSC2
T0PSC1
T0PSC0
R/W
R/W
R/W
¾
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
POR
0
0
¾
0
1
0
0
0
Bit 7,6
T0M1, T0M0: Timer0 operation mode selection
00: no mode available
01: event counter mode
10: timer mode
11: pulse width capture mode
Bit 5
Not implemented, read as ²0²
Bit 4
T0ON: Timer/event counter counting enable
0: disable
1: enable
Bit 3
T0EG:
Event counter active edge selection
0: count on raising edge
1: count on falling edge
Pulse Width Capture active edge selection
0: start counting on falling edge, stop on rasing edge
1: start counting on raising edge, stop on falling edge
Bit 2~0
T0PSC2, T0PSC1, T0PSC0: Timer prescaler rate selection
Timer internal clock=
000: fSYS
001: fSYS/2
010: fSYS/4
011: fSYS/8
100: fSYS/16
101: fSYS/32
110: fSYS/64
111: fSYS/128
Rev. 1.00
50
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
· TMR1C Register
¨
HT56R22
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Name
T1M1
T1M0
¾
T1ON
T1EG
T1PSC2
T1PSC1
T1PSC0
R/W
R/W
R/W
¾
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
POR
0
0
¾
0
1
0
0
0
Bit 7,6
T1M1, T1M0: Timer1 operation mode selection
00: no mode available
01: event counter mode
10: timer mode
11: pulse width capture mode
Bit 5
Not implemented, read as ²0²
Bit 4
T1ON: Timer/event counter counting enable
0: disable
1: enable
Bit 3
T1EG:
Event counter active edge selection
0: count on raising edge
1: count on falling edge
Pulse Width Capture active edge selection
0: start counting on falling edge, stop on rasing edge
1: start counting on raising edge, stop on falling edge
Bit 2~0
T1PSC2, T1PSC1, T1PSC0: Timer prescaler rate selection
Timer internal clock=
000: fSYS
001: fSYS/2
010: fSYS/4
011: fSYS/8
100: fSYS/16
101: fSYS/32
110: fSYS/64
111: fSYS/128
Rev. 1.00
51
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
· TMR1C Register
¨
HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Name
T1M1
T1M0
T1S
T1ON
T1EG
¾
¾
¾
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
¾
¾
¾
POR
0
0
0
0
1
¾
¾
¾
Bit 7,6
T1M1, T1M0: Timer 1 Operation mode selection
00: no mode available
01: event counter mode
10: timer mode
11: pulse width capture mode
Bit 5
T1S: timer clock source
0: fSYS/4
1: LXT oscillator
T1ON: Timer/event counter counting enable
0: disable
1: enable
Bit 4
Bit 3
T1EG:
Event counter active edge selection
0: count on raising edge
1: count on falling edge
Pulse Width Capture active edge selection
0: start counting on falling edge, stop on rasing edge
1: start counting on raising edge, stop on falling edge
Bit 2~0
unimplemented, read as ²0²
· TMR2C Register
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Name
T2M1
T2M0
¾
T2ON
T2EG
T2PSC2
T2PSC1
T2PSC0
R/W
R/W
R/W
¾
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
POR
0
0
¾
0
1
0
0
0
Bit 7, 6
T2M1, T2M0: Timer 2 Operation mode selection
00: no mode available
01: event counter mode
10: timer mode
11: pulse width capture mode
Bit 5
unimplemented, read as ²0²
Bit 4
T2ON: Timer/event counter counting enable
0: disable
1: enable
Bit 3
T2EG:
Event counter active edge selection
0: count on raising edge
1: count on falling edge
Pulse Width Capture active edge selection
0: start counting on falling edge, stop on rasing edge
1: start counting on raising edge, stop on falling edge
Bit 2~0
T2PSC2, T2PSC1, T2PSC0: Timer prescaler rate selection
Timer internal clock=
000: fSYS
001: fSYS/2
010: fSYS/4
011: fSYS/8
100: fSYS/16
101: fSYS/32
110: fSYS/64
111: fSYS/128
Rev. 1.00
52
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
· TMR3C Register
¨
HT56R25/26
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Name
T3M1
T3M0
¾
T3ON
T3EG
T3PSC2
T3PSC1
T3PSC0
R/W
R/W
R/W
¾
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
POR
0
0
¾
0
1
0
0
0
Bit 7, 6
T3M1, T3M0: Timer 3 Operation mode selection
00: no mode available
01: event counter mode
10: timer mode
11: pulse width capture mode
Bit 5
unimplemented, read as ²0²
Bit 4
T3ON: Timer/event counter counting enable
0: disable
1: enable
Bit 3
T3EG:
Event counter active edge selection
0: count on raising edge
1: count on falling edge
Pulse Width Capture active edge selection
0: start counting on falling edge, stop on rasing edge
1: start counting on raising edge, stop on falling edge
Bit 2~0
T3PSC2, T3PSC1, T3PSC0: Timer prescaler rate selection
Timer internal clock=
000: fSYS
001: fSYS/2
010: fSYS/4
011: fSYS/8
100: fSYS/16
101: fSYS/32
110: fSYS/64
111: fSYS/128
Rev. 1.00
53
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
Timer Mode
be set high to enable the Timer/Event Counter to run. If
the Active Edge Select bit, TnEG, which is bit 3 of the
Timer Control Register, is low, the Timer/Event Counter
will increment each time the external timer pin receives
a low to high transition. If the TnEG is high, the counter
will increment each time the external timer pin receives
a high to low transition. When it is full and overflows, an
interrupt signal is generated and the Timer/Event Counter will reload the value already loaded into the preload
register and continue counting. The interrupt can be disabled by ensuring that the Timer/Event Counter Interrupt Enable bit in the corresponding Interrupt Control
Register, is reset to zero.
In this mode, the Timer/Event Counter can be utilised to
measure fixed time intervals, providing an internal interrupt signal each time the Timer/Event Counter overflows. To operate in this mode, the Operating Mode
Select bit pair, TnM1/TnM0, in the Timer Control Register must be set to the correct value as shown.
Bit7 Bit6
Control Register Operating Mode
Select Bits for the Timer Mode
1
0
In this mode the internal clock is used as the timer clock.
The timer input clock source is either fSYS , fSYS/4 or the
LXT oscillator. However, this timer clock source is further divided by a prescaler, the value of which is determined by the bits TnPSC2~TnPSC0 in the Timer
Control Register. The timer-on bit, TnON must be set
high to enable the timer to run. Each time an internal
clock high to low transition occurs, the timer increments
by one; when the timer is full and overflows, an interrupt
signal is generated and the timer will reload the value already loaded into the preload register and continue
counting. A timer overflow condition and corresponding
internal interrupt is one of the wake-up sources, however, the internal interrupts can be disabled by ensuring
that the TnE bits of the INTCn register are reset to zero.
As the external timer pin is shared with an I/O pin, to ensure that the pin is configured to operate as an event
counter input pin, two things have to happen. The first is
to ensure that the Operating Mode Select bits in the
Timer Control Register place the Timer/Event Counter in
the Event Counting Mode, the second is to ensure that
the port control register configures the pin as an input. It
should be noted that in the event counting mode, even if
the microcontroller is in the Idle/Sleep Mode, the
Timer/Event Counter will continue to record externally
changing logic events on the timer input TCn pin. As a
result when the timer overflows it will generate a timer
interrupt and corresponding wake-up source.
Event Counter Mode
Pulse Width Capture Mode
In this mode, a number of externally changing logic
events, occurring on the external timer TCn pin, can be
recorded by the Timer/Event Counter. To operate in this
mode, the Operating Mode Select bit pair, TnM1/TnM0,
in the Timer Control Register must be set to the correct
value as shown.
Control Register Operating Mode
Select Bits for the Event Counter Mode
In this mode, the Timer/Event Counter can be utilised to
measure the width of external pulses applied to the external timer pin. To operate in this mode, the Operating
Mode Select bit pair, TnM1/TnM0, in the Timer Control
Register must be set to the correct value as shown.
Control Register Operating Mode
Select Bits for the Pulse Width
Capture Mode
Bit7 Bit6
0
1
In this mode, the external timer TCn pin, is used as the
Timer/Event Counter clock source, however it is not divided by the internal prescaler. After the other bits in the
Timer Control Register have been setup, the enable bit
TnON, which is bit 4 of the Timer Control Register, can
Bit7 Bit6
1
1
In this mode the internal clock, fSYS , fSYS/4 or the LXT, is
used as the internal clock for the 8-bit Timer/Event
Counter. However, the clock source, fSYS, for the 8-bit
timer is further divided by a prescaler, the value of which
is determined by the Prescaler Rate Select bits
P r e s c a le r O u tp u t
In c re m e n t
T im e r C o n tr o lle r
T im e r + 1
T im e r + 2
T im e r + N
T im e r + N + 1
Timer Mode Timing Chart
E x te rn a l E v e n t
In c re m e n t
T im e r C o u n te r
T im e r + 1
T im e r + 2
T im e r + 3
Event Counter Mode Timing Chart (TnEG=1)
Rev. 1.00
54
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
E x te rn a l T C n
P in In p u t
T n O N - w ith T n E = 0
P r e s c a le r O u tp u t
In c re m e n t
T im e r C o u n te r
T im e r
+ 1
+ 2
+ 3
+ 4
P r e s c a le r O u tp u t is s a m p le d a t e v e r y fa llin g e d g e o f T 1 .
Pulse Width Capture Mode Timing Chart (TnE=0)
the Operating Mode Select bits in the Timer Control
Register place the Timer/Event Counter in the pulse
width capture Mode, the second is to ensure that the
port control register configures the pin as an input.
TnPSC2~TnPSC0, which are bits 2~0 in the Timer Control Register. After the other bits in the Timer Control
Register have been setup, the enable bit TnON, which is
bit 4 of the Timer Control Register, can be set high to enable the Timer/Event Counter, however it will not actually start counting until an active edge is received on the
external timer pin.
Prescaler
Bits TnPSC0~TnPSC2 of the TMRnC register can be
used to define a division ratio for the internal clock
source of the Timer/Event Counter enabling longer time
out periods to be setup.
If the Active Edge Select bit TnEG, which is bit 3 of the
Timer Control Register, is low, once a high to low transition has been received on the external timer pin, the
Timer/Event Counter will start counting until the external
timer pin returns to its original high level. At this point the
enable bit will be automatically reset to zero and the
Timer/Event Counter will stop counting. If the Active
Edge Select bit is high, the Timer/Event Counter will begin counting once a low to high transition has been received on the external timer pin and stop counting when
the external timer pin returns to its original low level. As
before, the enable bit will be automatically reset to zero
and the Timer/Event Counter will stop counting. It is important to note that in the pulse width capture Mode, the
enable bit is automatically reset to zero when the external control signal on the external timer pin returns to its
original level, whereas in the other two modes the enable bit can only be reset to zero under program control.
Programmable Frequency Divider - PFD
The Programmable Frequency Divider provides a
means of producing a variable frequency output suitable
for applications requiring a precise frequency generator.
The PFD output is pin-shared with the I/O pin PA3. The
PFD function is selected via configuration option, however, if not selected, the pin can operate as a normal I/O
pin.
The clock source for the PFD circuit can originate from
either Timer/Event Counter 0 or Timer/Event Counter 1
overflow signal selected via configuration option. The
output frequency is controlled by loading the required
values into the timer registers and prescaler registers to
give the required division ratio. The timer will begin to
count-up from this preload register value until full, at
which point an overflow signal is generated, causing the
PFD output to change state. The timer will then be automatically reloaded with the preload register value and
continue counting-up.
The residual value in the Timer/Event Counter, which
can now be read by the program, therefore represents
the length of the pulse received on the TCn pin. As the
enable bit has now been reset, any further transitions on
the external timer pin will be ignored. The timer cannot
begin further pulse width capture until the enable bit is
set high again by the program. In this way, single shot
pulse measurements can be easily made.
For the PFD output to function, it is essential that the corresponding bit of the Port A control register PAC bit 3 is setup
as an output. If setup as an input the PFD output will not
function, however, the pin can still be used as a normal input pin. The PFD output will only be activated if bit PA3 is
set to ²1². This output data bit is used as the on/off control
bit for the PFD output. Note that the PFD output will be low
if the PA3 output data bit is cleared to ²0².
It should be noted that in this mode the Timer/Event
Counter is controlled by logical transitions on the external
timer pin and not by the logic level. When the Timer/Event
Counter is full and overflows, an interrupt signal is generated and the Timer/Event Counter will reload the value already loaded into the preload register and continue
counting. The interrupt can be disabled by ensuring that
the Timer/Event Counter Interrupt Enable bit in the corresponding Interrupt Control Register, is reset to zero.
Using this method of frequency generation, and if a
crystal oscillator is used for the system clock, very precise values of frequency can be generated.
As the TCn pin is shared with an I/O pin, to ensure that
the pin is configured to operate as a pulse width capture
pin, two things have to happen. The first is to ensure that
Bits TnPSC0~TnPSC2 of the control register can be
used to define the pre-scaling stages of the internal
clock source of the Timer/Event Counter. The
Rev. 1.00
55
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
T im e r O v e r flo w
P F D
C lo c k
P A 1 D a ta
P F D
O u tp u t a t P A 1
PFD Function
must be taken to ensure that the timers are properly initialised before using them for the first time. The associated timer enable bits in the interrupt control register must
be properly set otherwise the internal interrupt associated
with the timer will remain inactive. The edge select, timer
mode and clock source control bits in timer control register must also be correctly set to ensure the timer is properly configured for the required application. It is also
important to ensure that an initial value is first loaded into
the timer registers before the timer is switched on; this is
because after power-on the initial values of the timer registers are unknown. After the timer has been initialised
the timer can be turned on and off by controlling the enable bit in the timer control register.
Timer/Event Counter overflow signal can be used to
generate signals for the PFD and Timer Interrupt.
I/O Interfacing
The Timer/Event Counter, when configured to run in the
event counter or pulse width capture mode, requires the
use of an external timer pin for its operation. As this pin is
a shared pin it must be configured correctly to ensure that
it is setup for use as a Timer/Event Counter input pin. This
is achieved by ensuring that the mode select bits in the
Timer/Event Counter control register, select either the
event counter or pulse width capture mode. Additionally
the corresponding Port Control Register bit must be set
high to ensure that the pin is setup as an input. Any
pull-high resistor connected to this pin will remain valid
even if the pin is used as a Timer/Event Counter input.
When the Timer/Event Counter overflows, its corresponding interrupt request flag in the interrupt control
register will be set. If the Timer/Event Counter interrupt
is enabled this will in turn generate an interrupt signal.
However irrespective of whether the interrupts are enabled or not, a Timer/Event Counter overflow will also
generate a wake-up signal if the device is in a
Power-down condition. This situation may occur if the
Timer/Event Counter is in the Event Counting Mode and
if the external signal continues to change state. In such
a case, the Timer/Event Counter will continue to count
these external events and if an overflow occurs the device will be woken up from its Power-down condition. To
prevent such a wake-up from occurring, the timer interrupt request flag should first be set high before issuing
the ²HALT² instruction to enter the Idle/Sleep Mode.
Programming Considerations
When configured to run in the timer mode, the internal
system clock is used as the timer clock source and is
therefore synchronised with the overall operation of the
microcontroller. In this mode when the appropriate timer
register is full, the microcontroller will generate an internal
interrupt signal directing the program flow to the respective internal interrupt vector. For the pulse width capture
mode, the internal system clock is also used as the timer
clock source but the timer will only run when the correct
logic condition appears on the external timer input pin. As
this is an external event and not synchronised with the internal timer clock, the microcontroller will only see this external event when the next timer clock pulse arrives. As a
result, there may be small differences in measured values requiring programmers to take this into account during programming. The same applies if the timer is
configured to be in the event counting mode, which again
is an external event and not synchronised with the internal system or timer clock.
Timer Program Example
The program shows how the Timer/Event Counter registers are setup along with how the interrupts are enabled
and managed. Note how the Timer/Event Counter is
turned on, by setting bit 4 of the Timer Control Register.
The Timer/Event Counter can be turned off in a similar
way by clearing the same bit. This example program sets
the Timer/Event Counters to be in the timer mode, which
uses the internal system clock as their clock source.
When the Timer/Event Counter is read, or if data is written to the preload register, the clock is inhibited to avoid
errors, however as this may result in a counting error, this
should be taken into account by the programmer. Care
Rev. 1.00
56
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
· PFD Programming Example
org 04h
; external interrupt vector
org 08h
; Timer Counter 0 interrupt vector
jmp tmr0int
; jump here when Timer 0 overflows
:
:
org 20h
; main program
:
:
;internal Timer 0 interrupt routine
tmr0int:
:
; Timer 0 main program placed here
:
:
begin:
;setup Timer 0 registers
mov a,09bh
; setup Timer 0 preload value
mov tmr0,a
mov a,081h
; setup Timer 0 control register
mov tmr0c,a
; timer mode and prescaler set to /2
;setup interrupt register
mov a,00dh
; enable master interrupt and both timer interrupts
mov intc0,a
:
:
set tmr0c.4
; start Timer 0
:
:
Time Base
The device includes a Time Base function which is used to generate a regular time interval signal.
The Time Base time interval magnitude is determined using an internal 12~15 stage counter which sets the division ratio of the clock source. This division ratio is controlled by the time base divider configuration option. The clock source is
selected using a peripheral clock configuration option.
When the Time Base times out, a Time Base interrupt signal will be generated. It should be noted that as the Time Base
clock source is the same as the Timer/Event Counter clock source, care should be taken when programming.
Rev. 1.00
57
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
Pulse Width Modulator
The devices contains a series of Pulse Width
Modulation, PWM, outputs. Useful for such applications
such as motor speed control, the PWM function
provides an output with a fixed frequency but with a duty
cycle that can be varied by setting particular values into
the corresponding PWM register.
Part No.
Channels
All devices
4
PWM
Mode
8+4
8+4 PWM Mode Modulation
Each full PWM cycle, as it is 12-bits wide, has 4096 clock
periods. However, in the 8+4 PWM mode, each PWM cycle is subdivided into sixteen individual sub-cycles known
as modulation cycle 0 ~ modulation cycle 15, denoted as
²i² in the table. Each one of these sixteen sub-cycles contains 256 clock cycles. In this mode, a modulation frequency increase of sixteen is achieved. The 12-bit PWM
register value, which represents the overall duty cycle of
the PWM waveform, is divided into two groups. The first
group which consists of bit4~bit11 is denoted here as the
DC value. The second group which consists of bit0~bit3
is known as the AC value. In the 8+4 PWM mode, the
duty cycle value of each of the two modulation sub-cycles
is shown in the following table.
Output Register
Pin
Names
PD0~
PD3
PWM0L~
PWM3L
PWM0H~
PWM3H
PWM Overview
A register pair, located in the Data Memory is assigned
to each Pulse Width Modulator output and are known as
the PWM registers. It is in each register pair that the
12-bit value, which represents the overall duty cycle of
one modulation cycle of the output waveform, should be
placed. The PWM registers also contain the enable/disable control bit for the PWM outputs. To increase the
PWM modulation frequency, each modulation cycle is
modulated into sixteen individual modulation
sub-sections, known as the 8+4 mode. Note that it is
only necessary to write the required modulation value
into the corresponding PWM register as the subdivision
of the waveform into its sub-modulation cycles is implemented automatically within the microcontroller hardware. The PWM clock source is the system clock fSYS.
Parameter
Modulation cycle i
(i=0~15)
PWM Cycle
Frequency
PWM Cycle
Duty
fSYS/256
fSYS/4096
(PWM register
value)/4096
Rev. 1.00
DC (Duty Cycle)
i<AC
DC+1
256
i³AC
DC
256
8+4 Mode Modulation Cycle Values
The accompanying diagram illustrates the waveforms
associated with the 8+4 mode of PWM operation. It is
important to note how the single PWM cycle is subdivided into 16 individual modulation cycles, numbered
0~15 and how the AC value is related to the PWM value.
PWM Output Control
This method of dividing the original modulation cycle
into a further 16 sub-cycles enables the generation of
higher PWM frequencies, which allow a wider range of
applications to be served. As long as the periods of the
generated PWM pulses are less than the time constants
of the load, the PWM output will be suitable as such long
time constant loads will average out the pulses of the
PWM output. The difference between what is known as
the PWM cycle frequency and the PWM modulation frequency should be understood. As the PWM clock is the
system clock, fSYS, and as the PWM value is 12-bits
wide, the overall PWM cycle frequency is fSYS/4096.
However, when in the 8+4 mode of operation, the PWM
modulation frequency will be fSYS/256.
PWM
Modulation
Frequency
AC (0~15)
The four PWM0~PWM3 outputs are shared with pins
PD0~PD3. To operate as a PWM output and not as an
I/O pin, bit 0 of the relevant PWM register bit must be set
high. A zero must also be written to the corresponding
bit in the PDC port control register, to ensure that the
PWM0 output pin is setup as an output. After these two
initial steps have been carried out, and of course after
the required PWM 12-bit value has been written into the
PWM register pair register, writing a ²1² to the corresponding PD data register will enable the PWM data to
appear on the pin. Writing a ²0² to the bit will disable the
PWM output function and force the output low. In this
way, the Port D data output register bits, can also be
used as an on/off control for the PWM function. Note
that if the enable bit in the PWM register is set high to
enable the PWM function, but a ²1² has been written to
its corresponding bit in the PDC control register to configure the pin as an input, then the pin can still function
as a normal input line, with pull-high resistor selections.
58
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
PWM Programming Example
The following sample program shows how the PWM output is setup and controlled.
mov
mov
clr
clr
set
set
:
:
clr
fS
Y S
a,64h
pwm0h,a
pwm0l
pdc.0
pwm0en
pd.0
:
:
pd.0
;
;
;
;
;
;
setup PWM0 value to 1600 decimal which is 640H
setup PWM0H register value
setup PWM0L register value
setup pin PD0 as an output
set the PWM0 enable bit
Enable the PWM0 output
; PWM0 output disabled - PD0 will remain low
/2
[P W M ] = 1 6 0 0
P W M
1 0 0 /2 5 6
1 0 0 /2 5 6
1 0 0 /2 5 6
1 0 0 /2 5 6
1 0 0 /2 5 6
1 0 1 /2 5 6
1 0 0 /2 5 6
1 0 0 /2 5 6
1 0 0 /2 5 6
1 0 1 /2 5 6
1 0 1 /2 5 6
1 0 1 /2 5 6
1 0 0 /2 5 6
1 0 0 /2 5 6
1 0 1 /2 5 6
1 0 1 /2 5 6
1 0 1 /2 5 6
[P W M ] = 1 6 0 1
P W M
[P W M ] = 1 6 0 2
P W M
[P W M ] = 1 6 1 5
P W M
1 0 1 /2 5 6
P W M
1 0 1 /2 5 6
m o d u la tio n p e r io d : 2 5 6 /fS
M o d u la tio n c y c le 0
1 0 1 /2 5 6
Y S
M o d u la tio n c y c le 1
P W M
M o d u la tio n c y c le 2
c y c le : 4 0 9 6 /fS
M o d u la tio n c y c le 1 5
M o d u la tio n c y c le 0
Y S
8+4 PWM Mode
P W M 0 H ~ P W M 3 H
H ig h B y te R e g is te r s
b 7
1 1
1 0
9
8
7
6
5
P W M 0 L ~ P W M 3 L
L o w B y te R e g is te r s
b 0
4
b 7
3
2
1
0
b 0
P W M n E N
P W M
R e g is te r s (n = 0 ~ 3 )
P W M O n /O ff C o n tro l
1 : P W M e n a b le
0 : I/O p in e n a b le
N o t im p le m e n te d , r e a d a s " 0 "
P W M A C
b its 0 ~ 3
V a lu e
P W M D C V a lu e
b its 4 ~ 1 1
PWM Register Pairs
Rev. 1.00
59
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
Analog to Digital Converter
The need to interface to real world analog signals is a
common requirement for many electronic systems.
However, to properly process these signals by a
microcontroller, they must first be converted into digital
signals by A/D converters. By integrating the A/D conversion electronic circuitry into the microcontroller, the
need for external components is reduced significantly
with the corresponding follow-on benefits of lower costs
and reduced component space requirements.
In the following table, D0~D11 is the A/D conversion
data result bits.
A/D Overview
A/D Converter Control Registers ADCR, ACSR, ADPCR
A/D Converter Data Registers - ADRL, ADRH
Bit
5
Bit
4
ADRL
D3
D2
D1
D0
¾
¾
¾
¾
ADRH
D11 D10 D9
D8
D7
D6
D5
D4
Bit
1
Bit
0
Y S
C lo c k
D iv id e r
¸ N
P A 0 /A N 0
P A 1 /A N 1
A D R L
A D C
A D R H
P A 6 /A N 6
P A 7 /A N 7
C h a n n e l S e le c t
B its
Bit
2
The ADPCR control register contains the PCR7~PCR0
bits which determine which pins on PA7~PA0 are used as
analog inputs for the A/D converter and which pins are to
be used as normal I/O pins. If PCR7~PCR0 has a value
of ²11111111², then all eight pins, namely AN7~AN0 will
all be set as analog inputs. Note that if the PCR7~PCR0
bits are all set to zero, then all the PA7~PA0 pins will be
setup as normal I/Os.
fS
A D C S 0 ~ A D C S 2
Bit
3
The ACS2~ACS0 bits in the ADCR register define the
channel number. As the device contains only one actual
analog to digital converter circuit, each of the individual
8 analog inputs must be routed to the converter. It is the
function of the ACS2~ACS0 bits in the ADCR register to
determine which analog channel is actually connected
to the internal A/D converter.
The device, which has an internal 12-bit A/D converter,
requires two data registers, a high byte register, known
as ADRH, and a low byte register, known as ADRL. After
the conversion process takes place, these registers can
be directly read by the microcontroller to obtain the digitised conversion value. Only the high byte register,
ADRH, utilises its full 8-bit contents. The low byte register utilises only 4 bit of its 8-bit contents as it contains
only the lowest bits of the 12-bit converted value.
A D O N B B it
A /D E n a b le
Bit
6
To control the function and operation of the A/D converter, three control registers known as ADCR, ACSR
and ADPCR are provided. These 8-bit registers define
functions such as the selection of which analog channel
is connected to the internal A/D converter, which pins
are used as analog inputs and which are used as normal
I/Os, the A/D clock source as well as controlling the start
function and monitoring the A/D converter end of conversion status.
The accompanying block diagram shows the overall internal structure of the A/D converter, together with its associated registers.
R e g is te r
Bit
7
A/D Data Registers
The device contains an 8-channel analog to digital converter which can directly interface to external analog signals, such as that from sensors or other control signals
and convert these signals directly into either a 12-bit digital value.
A C S R
Register
S T A R T
S ta r t B it
E O C B
A /D D a ta
R e g is te r s
A D C R
R e g is te r
E n d o f
C o n v e r s io n B it
A/D Converter Structure
Rev. 1.00
60
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
· ADRH, ADRL Register
ADRH
ADRL
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Name
D11
D10
D9
D8
D7
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
D0
¾
¾
¾
¾
R/W
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
¾
¾
¾
¾
POR
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
¾
¾
¾
¾
²x² unknown
unimplemented, read as ²0²
D11~D0: ADC conversion data
· ADCR Register
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Name
START
EOCB
¾
R/W
R/W
R
¾
¾
¾
ACS2
ACS1
ACS0
¾
¾
R/W
R/W
R/W
POR
0
1
¾
¾
¾
0
0
0
Bit 7
START: Start the A/D conversion
0®1®0 : start
0®1
: reset the A/D converter and set EOCB to ²1²
Bit 6
EOCB: End of A/D conversion flag
0: A/D conversion ended
1: A/D conversion in progress
Bit 5~3
unimplemented, read as ²0²
Bit 2~0
ACS2~ACS0: Select A/D channel
000 AN0
001 AN1
010 AN2
011 AN3
100 AN4
101 AN5
110 AN6
111 AN7
Rev. 1.00
61
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
· ADPCR Register
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Name
PCR7
PCR6
PCR5
PCR4
PCR3
PCR2
PCR1
PCR0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
POR
x
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
²x² unknown
Port PA - A/D converter input pin selection
Bit 7
PCR7: PA7 or AN7
0: PA7 I/O pin or other pin-shared function
1: AN7 A/D converter input
Bit 6
PCR6: PA6 or AN6
0: PA6 I/O pin or other pin-shared function
1: AN6 A/D converter input
Bit 5
PCR5: PA5 or AN5
0: PA5 I/O pin or other pin-shared function
1: AN5 A/D converter input
Bit 4
PCR4: PA4 or AN4
0: PA4 I/O pin or other pin-shared function
1: AN4 A/D converter input
Bit 3
PCR3: PA3 or AN3
0: PA3 I/O pin or other pin-shared function
1: AN3 A/D converter input
Bit 2
PCR2: PA2 or AN2
0: PA2 I/O pin or other pin-shared function
1: AN2 A/D converter input
Bit 1
PCR1: PA1 or AN1
0: PA1 I/O pin or other pin-shared function
1: AN1 A/D converter input
Bit 0
PCR0: PA0 or AN0
0: PA0 I/O pin or other pin-shared function
1: AN0 A/D converter input
· ACSR Register
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Name
TEST
ADONB
¾
¾
¾
ADCS2
ADCS1
ADCS0
R/W
R/W
R/W
¾
¾
¾
R/W
R/W
R/W
POR
1
0
¾
¾
¾
0
0
0
Bit 7
TEST: for test mode use only
Bit 6
ADONB: ADC module power on/off control bit
0: ADC module power on
1: ADC module power off
Note: 1. it is recommended to set ADONB=1 before entering idle/sleep to reduce power
consumption
2. ADONB=1 will power down the ADC module.
Bit 5~3
unimplemented, read as ²0²
Bit 2~0
ADCS2~ADCS0: Select A/D converter clock source
000: system clock/2
001: system clock/8
010: system clock/32
011: undefined, can¢t be used.
100: system clock
101: system clock/4
110: system clock/16
111: undefined, can¢t be used.
Rev. 1.00
62
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
there are some limitations on the maximum A/D clock
source speed that can be selected. As the minimum value
of permissible A/D clock period, tAD, is 0.5ms, care must be
taken for system clock speeds in excess of 4MHz. For
system clock speeds in excess of 4MHz, the ADCS2,
ADCS1 and ADCS0 bits should not be set to ²000². Doing
so will give A/D clock periods that are less than the minimum A/D clock period which may result in inaccurate A/D
conversion values. Refer to the following table for examples, where values marked with an asterisk * show where,
depending upon the device, special care must be taken,
as the values may be less than the specified minimum A/D
Clock Period.
The START bit in the register is used to start and reset
the A/D converter. When themicrocontroller sets this bit
from low to high and then low again, an analog to digital
conversion cycle will be initiated. When the START bit is
brought from low to high but not low again, the EOCB bit
in the ADCR register will be set to a ²1² and the analog
to digital converter will be reset. It is the START bit that is
used to control the overall start operation of the internal
analog to digital converter.
The EOCB bit in the ADCR register is used to indicate
when the analog to digital conversion process is complete. This bit will be automatically set to ²0² by the
microcontroller after a conversion cycle has ended. In
addition, the corresponding A/D interrupt request flag
will be set in the interrupt control register, and if the interrupts are enabled, an appropriate internal interrupt signal will be generated. This A/D internal interrupt signal
will direct the program flow to the associated A/D internal interrupt address for processing. If the A/D internal
interrupt is disabled, the microcontroller can be used to
poll the EOCB bit in the ADCR register to check whether
it has been cleared as an alternative method of detecting the end of an A/D conversion cycle.
A/D Input Pins
All of the A/D analog input pins are pin-shared with the
I/O pins on Port A. Bits PCR7~PCR0 in the ADPCR register, determine whether the input pins are setup as normal Port A input/output pins or whether they are setup as
analog inputs. In this way, pins can be changed under
program control to change their function from normal I/O
operation to analog inputs and vice versa. Pull-high resistors, which are setup through register programming, apply to the input pins only when they are used as normal
I/O pins, if setup as A/D inputs the pull-high resistors will
be automatically disconnected. Note that it is not necessary to first setup the A/D pin as an input in the PAC port
control register to enable the A/D input as when the
PCR7~PCR0 bits enable an A/D input, the status of the
port control register will be overridden.
The clock source for the A/D converter, which originates
from the system clock fSYS, is first divided by a division
ratio, the value of which is determined by the ADCS2,
ADCS1 and ADCS0 bits in the ACSR register.
Controlling the power on/off function of the A/D converter circuitry is implemented using the value of the
ADONB bit.
Although the A/D clock source is determined by the system clock fSYS, and by bits ADCS2, ADCS1 and ADCS0,
A/D Clock Period (tAD)
ADCS2,
ADCS1,
ADCS0=000
(fSYS/2)
ADCS2,
ADCS1,
ADCS0=001
(fSYS/8)
ADCS2,
ADCS1,
ADCS0=010
(fSYS/32)
ADCS2,
ADCS1,
ADCS0=100
(fSYS)
ADCS2,
ADCS1,
ADCS0=101
(fSYS/4)
2ms
8ms
32ms
1ms
4ms
16ms
Undefined
2MHz
1ms
4ms
16ms
500ns
2ms
8ms
Undefined
4MHz
500ns
2ms
8ms
250ns*
1ms
4ms
Undefined
8MHz
250ns*
1ms
4ms
125ns*
500ns
2ms
Undefined
12MHz
167ns*
667ns
2.67ms
83ns*
333ns*
1ms
Undefined
fSYS
1MHz
ADCS2,
ADCS2,
ADCS1,
ADCS1,
ADCS0=110 ADCS0=011,
(fSYS/16)
111
A/D Clock Period Examples
Rev. 1.00
63
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
Summary of A/D Conversion Steps
The accompanying diagram shows graphically the various stages involved in an analog to digital conversion
process and its associated timing.
The following summarises the individual steps that
should be executed in order to implement an A/D conversion process.
The setting up and operation of the A/D converter function is fully under the control of the application program as
there are no configuration options associated with the
A/D converter. After an A/D conversion process has been
initiated by the application program, the microcontroller
internal hardware will begin to carry out the conversion,
during which time the program can continue with other
functions. The time taken for the A/D conversion is 16tAD
where tAD is equal to the A/D clock period.
· Step 1
Select the required A/D conversion clock by correctly
programming bits ADCS2, ADCS1 and ADCS0 in the
register.
· Step 2
Select which pins are to be used as A/D inputs and
configure them as A/D input pins by correctly programming the PCR7~PCR0 bits in the ADPCR register.
· Step 3
Programming Considerations
Enable the A/D by clearing the ADONB in the ACSR
register to zero.
When programming, special attention must be given to
the PCR7~PCR0 bits in the ADPCR register. If these
bits are all cleared to zero no external pins will be selected for use as A/D input pins allowing the pins to be
used as normal I/O pins. Setting the ADONB bit high has
the ability to power down the internal A/D circuitry, which
may be an important consideration in power sensitive
applications. The ADONB bit should be set high before
entering any of the low power operating modes or before a HALT instruction is executed to reduce power
consumption.
· Step 4
Select which channel is to be connected to the internal
A/D converter by correctly programming the
ACS2~ACS0 bits which are also contained in the register.
· Step 5
If the interrupts are to be used, the interrupt control
registers must be correctly configured to ensure the
A/D converter interrupt function is active. The master
interrupt control bit, EMI, in the INTC0 interrupt control
register must be set to ²1², the multi-function interrupt
enable bit, EMFI, in the INTC1 register and the A/D
converter interrupt bit, EADI, in the INTC1 register
must also be set to ²1².
A/D Transfer Function
As the device contain a 12-bit A/D converter, its
full-scale converted digitised value is equal to FFFH.
Since the full-scale analog input value is equal to the
VDD voltage, this gives a single bit analog input value of
VDD/4096. The diagram show the ideal transfer function
between the analog input value and the digitised output
value for the A/D converter.
· Step 6
The analog to digital conversion process can now be
initialised by setting the START bit in the ADCR register from ²0² to ²1² and then to ²0² again. Note that this
bit should have been originally set to ²0².
Note that to reduce the quantisation error, a 0.5 LSB offset is added to the A/D Converter input. Except for the
digitised zero value, the subsequent digitised values will
change at a point 0.5 LSB below where they would
change without the offset, and the last full scale digitised
value will change at a point 1.5 LSB below the VDD level.
· Step 7
To check when the analog to digital conversion process is complete, the EOCB bit in the ADCR register
can be polled. The conversion process is complete
when this bit goes low. When this occurs the A/D data
registers ADRL and ADRH can be read to obtain the
conversion value. As an alternative method if the interrupts are enabled and the stack is not full, the program can wait for an A/D interrupt to occur.
Note:
A/D Programming Example
The following two programming examples illustrate how
to setup and implement an A/D conversion. In the first
example, the method of polling the EOCB bit in the
ADCR register is used to detect when the conversion
cycle is complete, whereas in the second example, the
A/D interrupt is used to determine when the conversion
is complete.
When checking for the end of the conversion
process, if the method of polling the EOCB bit in
the ADCR register is used, the interrupt enable
step above can be omitted.
Rev. 1.00
64
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
Example: using an EOCB polling method to detect the end of conversion
clr EADI
; disable ADC interrupt
mov a,00000001B
mov ACSR,a
; select fSYS/8 as A/D clock and turn on ADONB bit
mov a,00100000B
; setup ADCR register to configure Port PB0~PB3
; as A/D inputs
mov ADCR,a
; and select AN0 to be connected to the A/D converter
:
:
; As the Port B channel bits have changed the
; following START
; signal (0-1-0) must be issued
; instruction cycles
:
Start_conversion:
clr START
set START
; reset A/D
clr START
; start A/D
Polling_EOC:
sz
EOCB
; poll the ADCR register EOCB bit to detect end
; of A/D conversion
jmp polling_EOC
; continue polling
mov a,ADRL
; read low byte conversion result value
mov adrl_buffer,a
; save result to user defined register
mov a,ADRH
; read high byte conversion result value
mov adrh_buffer,a
; save result to user defined register
:
jmp start_conversion
; start next A/D conversion
Example: using the interrupt method to detect the end of conversion
clr EADI
; disable ADC interrupt
mov a,00000001B
mov ACSR,a
; select fSYS/8 as A/D clock and turn on ADONB bit
mov
a,00100000B
mov
ADCR,a
:
; setup ADCR register to configure Port PB0~PB3
; as A/D inputs
; and select AN0 to be connected to the A/D
; As the Port B channel bits have changed the
; following START signal(0-1-0) must be issued
;
:
Start_conversion:
clr START
set START
clr START
clr ADF
set EADI
set EMFI
set EMI
:
:
:
; ADC interrupt service routine
ADC_:
mov acc_stack,a
a,STATUS
mov status_stack,a
:
:
mov a,ADRL
mov adrl_buffer,a
mov a,ADRH
mov adrh_buffer,a
:
:
EXIT__ISR:
mov a,status_stack
mov STATUS,a
mov a,acc_stack
clr ADF
reti
Rev. 1.00
;
;
;
;
;
;
reset A/D
start A/D
clear ADC interrupt request flag
enable ADC interrupt
enable multi-function interrupt
enable global interrupt
; save ACC to user defined memory
; save STATUS to user defined memory
;
;
;
;
read
save
read
save
low byte conversion result value
result to user defined register
high byte conversion result value
result to user defined register
; restore STATUS from user defined memory
; restore ACC from user defined memory
; clear ADC interrupt flag
65
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
P C R 2 ~
P C R 0
0 0 0 B
x x x B - P C R [2 :0 ] is n o t e q u a l to " 0 "
A D O N B
tO
A D C m o d u le
O N
N 2 S T
o n
A /D
tA
s a m p lin g tim e
A /D
tA
D C S
o ff
s a m p lin g tim e
o n
D C S
S T A R T
E O C B
A C S 2 ~
A C S 0
x x x B
P o w e r-o n
R e s e t
0 1 0 B
0 0 0 B
0 0 1 B
S ta rt o f A /D
c o n v e r s io n
S ta rt o f A /D
c o n v e r s io n
S ta rt o f A /D
c o n v e r s io n
R e s e t A /D
c o n v e rte r
R e s e t A /D
c o n v e rte r
1 : D e fin e p o r t c o n fig u r a tio n
2 : S e le c t a n a lo g c h a n n e l
A /D
N o te :
R e s e t A /D
c o n v e rte r
E n d o f A /D
c o n v e r s io n
A /D c lo c k m u s t b e fs y s , fS
tA D C S = 4 tA D
tA D C = 1 6 tA D
Y S
E n d o f A /D
c o n v e r s io n
tA D C
c o n v e r s io n tim e
/2 , fS
Y S
/4 , fS
Y S
/8 , fS
A /D
/1 6 o r fS
Y S
Y S
tA D C
c o n v e r s io n tim e
/3 2
A/D Conversion Timing
1 .5 L S B
F F F H
F F E H
F F D H
A /D C o n v e r s io n
R e s u lt
0 .5 L S B
0 3 H
0 2 H
0 1 H
0
1
2
3
4 0 9 3 4 0 9 4
4 0 9 5 4 0 9 6
(
V D D
)
4 0 9 6
A n a lo g In p u t V o lta g e
Ideal A/D Transfer Function
Rev. 1.00
66
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
Serial Interface Function
The communication is full duplex and operates as a
slave/master type, where the MCU can be either master
or slave. Although the SPI interface specification can
control multiple slave devices from a single master,
here, as only a single select pin, SCS, is provided only
one slave device can be connected to the SPI bus.
The device contains a Serial Interface Function, which
includes both the four line SPI interface and the two line
I2C interface types, to allow an easy method of communication with external peripheral hardware. Having relatively simple communication protocols, these serial
interface types allow the microcontroller to interface to
external SPI or I2C based hardware such as sensors,
Flash or EEPROM memory, etc. The SIM interface pins
are pin-shared with other I/O pins therefore the SIM interface function must first be selected using a configuration option. As both interface types share the same pins
and registers, the choice of whether the SPI or I2C type
is used is made using a bit in an internal register.
· SPI Interface Operation
The SPI interface is a full duplex synchronous serial
data link. It is a four line interface with pin names SDI,
SDO, SCK and SCS. Pins SDI and SDO are the Serial
Data Input and Serial Data Output lines, SCK is the
Serial Clock line and SCS is the Slave Select line. As
the SPI interface pins are pin-shared with normal I/O
pins and with the I2C function pins, the SPI interface
must first be enabled by selecting the SIM enable configuration option and setting the correct bits in the
SIMCTL0/SIMCTL2 register. After the SPI configuration option has been configured it can also be additionally disabled or enabled using the SIMEN bit in the
SIMCTL0 register. Communication between devices
connected to the SPI interface is carried out in a
slave/master mode with all data transfer initiations being implemented by the master. The Master also controls the clock signal. As the device only contains a
single SCS pin only one slave device can be utilised.
SPI Interface
The SPI interface is often used to communicate with external peripheral devices such as sensors, Flash or
EEPROM memory devices etc. Originally developed by
Motorola, the four line SPI interface is a synchronous
serial data interface that has a relatively simple communication protocol simplifying the programming requirements when communicating with external hardware
devices.
S P I S la v e
S P I M a s te r
S C K
S C K
The SPI function in this device offers the following features:
S D O
S D I
¨
Full duplex synchronous data transfer
S D O
¨
Both Master and Slave modes
S C S
¨
LSB first or MSB first data transmission modes
¨
Transmission complete flag
¨
Rising or falling active clock edge
¨
WCOL and CSEN bit enabled or disable select
S D I
S C S
SPI Master/Slave Connection
D a ta B u s
S IM D R
T x /R x S h ift R e g is te r
C K E G b it
C K P O L b it
C lo c k
E d g e /P o la r ity
C o n tro l
S C K P in
fS Y S
fS U B
T im e r /E v e n t C o u n te r
S D I P in
S D O
P in
E n a b le /D is a b le
B u s y
S ta tu s
C o n fig u r a tio n
O p tio n
W C O L F la g
T R F F la g
C lo c k
S o u r c e S e le c t
S C S P in
C S E N
b it
C o n fig u r a tio n
O p tio n
E n a b le /D is a b le
SPI Block Diagram
Rev. 1.00
67
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
The status of the SPI interface pins is determined by a
number of factors such as whether the device is in the
master or slave mode and upon the condition of certain control bits such as CSEN, SIMEN and SCS. In
the table I, Z represents an input floating condition.
There are several configuration options associated
with the SPI interface. One of these is to enable the
SIM function which selects the SIM pins rather than
normal I/O pins. Note that if the configuration option
does not select the SIM function then the SIMEN bit in
the SIMCTL0 register will have no effect. Another two
SIM configuration options determine if the CSEN and
WCOL bits are to be used.
There are also two control registers for the SPI interface, SIMCTL0 and SIMCTL2. Note that the SIMCTL2
register also has the name SIMAR which is used by the
I2C function. The SIMCTL1 register is not used by the
SPI function, only by the I 2 C function. Register
SIMCTL0 is used to control the enable/disable function
and to set the data transmission clock frequency. Although not connected with the SPI function, the
SIMCTL0 register is also used to control the Peripheral
Clock prescaler. Register SIMCTL2 is used for other
control functions such as LSB/MSB selection, write collision flag etc.
Configuration Option
The following gives further explanation of each
SIMCTL1 register bit:
Function
SIM Function
SIM interface or I/O pins
SPI CSEN bit
Enable/Disable
SPI WCOL bit
Enable/Disable
· SIMIDLE
The SIMIDLE bit is used to select if the SPI interface
continues running when the device is in the IDLE
mode. Setting the bit high allows the SPI interface to
maintain operation when the device is in the Idle
mode. Clearing the bit to zero disables any SPI operations when in the Idle mode.
This SPI/I2C idle mode control bit is located at
CLKMOD register bit4.
SPI Interface Configuration Options
SPI Registers
There are three internal registers which control the overall operation of the SPI interface. These are the SIMDR
data register and two control registers SIMCTL0 and
SIMCTL2. Note that the SIMCTL1 register is only used
by the I2C interface.
· SIMEN
The bit is the overall on/off control for the SPI interface. When the SIMEN bit is cleared to zero to disable
the SPI interface, the SDI, SDO, SCK and SCS lines
will be in a floating condition and the SPI operating
current will be reduced to a minimum value. When the
bit is high the SPI interface is enabled. The SIMconfiguration option must have first enabled the SIM interface for this bit to be effective. Note that when the
SIMEN bit changes from low to high the contents of
the SPI control registers will be in an unknown condition and should therefore be first initialised by the application program.
The SIMDR register is used to store the data being
transmitted and received. The same register is used by
b o t h t h e S P I and I 2 C f unc t i ons . B e f o r e t h e
microcontroller writes data to the SPI bus, the actual
data to be transmitted must be placed in the SIMDR register. After the data is received from the SPI bus, the
microcontroller can read it from the SIMDRregister. Any
transmission or reception of data from the SPI bus must
be made via the SIMDR register.
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
· SIM0~SIM2
0
These bits setup the overall operating mode of the SIM
function. As well as selecting if the I2C or SPI function,
they are used to control the SPI Master/Slave selection and the SPI Master clock frequency. The SPI
clock is a function of the system clock but can also be
chosen to be sourced from the Timer/Event Counter. If
the SPI Slave Mode is selected then the clock will be
supplied by an external Master device.
Label SD7 SD6 SD5 SD4 SD3 SD2 SD1 SD0
R/W
R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W
POR
X
Pin
SCS
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
Master - SIMEN=1
Slave - SIMEN=1
Master/Salve
SIMEN=0
CSEN=0
CSEN=1
CSEN=0
CSEN=1
SCS=0
CSEN=1
SCS=1
Z
Z
L
Z
I, Z
I, Z
SDO
Z
O
O
O
O
Z
SDI
Z
I, Z
I, Z
I, Z
I, Z
Z
SCK
Z
H: CKPOL=0
L: CKPOL=1
H: CKPOL=0
L: CKPOL=1
I, Z
I, Z
Z
Note:
²Z² floating, ²H² output high, ²L² output low, ²I² Input, ²O²output level, ²I,Z² input floating (no pull-high)
SPI Interface Pin Status
Rev. 1.00
68
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
b 7
S IM 2
b 0
S IM 1
S IM 0
P C K E N
P C K P S C 1 P C K P S C 0 S IM E N
S IM C T L 0 R e g is te r
N o t im p le m e n t e d , r e a d a s '0 "
S P I/I2C O n /O f c o n tro l
1 : e n a b le
0 : d is a b le
P e r ip h e r a l C lo c k C o n tr o l - d e s c r ib e d e ls e w h e r e
S P I/I2C
S IM 2
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
M a s te r /S la
S IM 1
S
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
v e a n d C lo c k
IM 0
m a s te r,
0
m a s te r,
1
0
m a s te r,
1
m a s te r,
0
m a s te r,
1
S la v e
I2C m o d
0
N o t u s e
1
C o n tro l
fS
fS
fS
fS
Y S
Y S
Y S
/4
/1 6
/6 4
U B
d
T im e r /E v e n t C o u n te r 0 o u tp u t/2
e
SPI/I2C Control Register - SIMCTL0
b 7
H C F
b 0
H A A S
H B B
H T X
T X A K
S R W
R X A K
S IM C T L 1 R e g is te r
R e c e iv e a c k n o w le d g e fla g
1 : n o t a c k n o w le d g e d
0 : a c k n o w le d g e d
N o t im p le m e n te d , r e a d a s " 0 "
M a s te r d a ta r e a d /w r ite r e q u e s t fla g
1 : re q u e s t d a ta re a d
0 : r e q u e s t d a ta w r ite
T r a n s m it a c k n o w le d g e fla g
1 : d o n 't a c k n o w le d g e
0 : a c k n o w le d g e
T r a n s m it/R e c e iv e m o d e
1 : tr a n s m it m o d e
0 : r e c e iv e m o d e
I2 C b u s b u s y fla g
1 : b u s y
0 : n o t b u s y
C a llin g a d d r e s s m a tc h e d fla g
1 : m a tc h e d
0 : n o t m a tc h e d
D a ta tr a n s fe r fla g
1 : tr a n s fe r c o m p le te
0 : tr a n s fe r n o t c o m p le te
I2C Control Register - SIMCTL1
b 0
b 7
C K P O L
C K E G
M L S
C S E N
W C O L
T R F
S IM C T L 2 R e g is te r
T r a n s m it/R e c e iv e c o m p le te fla g
1 : fin is h e d
0 : in p r o g r e s s
W r ite c o llis io n fla g
1 : c o llis io n
0 : n o c o llis io n
S C S p in e n a b le
1 : e n a b le
0 : S C S flo a tin g
D a ta s h ift o r d e r
1 : M S B
0 : L S B
S P I C lo c k E d g e S e le c t
1 : s e e te x t
0 : s e e te x t
S P I C lo c k P o la r ity
1 : s e e te x t
0 : s e e te x t
N o t im p le m e n te d , r e a d a s " 0 "
SPI Control Register - SIMCTL2
Rev. 1.00
69
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
CKPOL
CKEG
SCK Clock Signal
0
0
High Base Level
Active Rising Edge
0
1
High Base Level
Active Falling Edge
SPI Master, fSUB
1
0
Low Base Level
Active Falling Edge
0
SPI Master Timer/Event
Counter 0 output/2
1
1
Low Base Level
Active Rising Edge
0
1
SPI Slave
1
1
0
I2C mode
SPI Communication
1
1
0
Not used
After the SPI interface is enabled by setting the SIMEN
bit high, then in the Master Mode, when data is written to
the SIMDR register, transmission/reception will begin simultaneously. When the data transfer is complete, the
TRF flag will be set automatically, but must be cleared
using the application program. In the Slave Mode, when
the clock signal from the master has been received, any
data in the SIMDR register will be transmitted and any
data on the SDI pin will be shifted into the SIMDR register. The master should output an SCS signal to enable
the slave device before a clock signal is provided and
slave data transfers should be enabled/disabled before/after an SCS signal is received.
The SPI will continue to function even after a HALT instruction has been executed.
SPI Master/Slave Clock
Control and I2C Enable
SIM0
SIM1
SIM2
0
0
0
SPI Master, fSYS/4
0
0
1
SPI Master, fSYS/16
0
1
0
SPI Master, fSYS/64
0
1
1
1
0
1
SPI Control Register - SIMCTL2
The SIMCTL2 register is also used by the I2C interface
but has the name SIMAR.
· TRF
The TRF bit is the Transmit/Receive Complete flag and
is set high automatically when an SPI data transmission is completed, but must be cleared by the application program. It can be used to generate an interrupt.
· WCOL
The WCOL bit is used to detect if a data collision has
occurred. If this bit is high it means that data has been
attempted to be written to the SIMDR register during a
data transfer operation. This writing operation will be
ignored if data is being transferred. The bit can be
cleared by the application program. Note that using
the WCOL bit can be disabled or enabled via configuration option.
I2C Interface
The I2C interface is used to communicate with external
peripheral devices such as sensors, EEPROM memory
etc. Originally developed by Philips, it is a two line low
speed serial interface for synchronous serial data transfer. The advantage of only two lines for communication,
relatively simple communication protocol and the ability
to accommodate multiple devices on the same bus has
made it an extremely popular interface type for many
applications.
· CSEN
The CSEN bit is used as an on/off control for the SCS
pin. If this bit is low then the SCS pin will be disabled
and placed into a floating condition. If the bit is high
the SCS pin will be enabled and used as a select pin.
Note that using the CSEN bit can be disabled or enabled via configuration option.
· I2C Interface Operation
· MLS
The I2C serial interface is a two line interface, a serial
data line, SDA, and serial clock line, SCL. As many
devices may be connected together on the same bus,
their outputs are both open drain types. For this reason it is necessary that external pull-high resistors are
connected to these outputs. Note that no chip select
line exists, as each device on the I2C bus is identified
by a unique address which will be transmitted and received on the I2C bus.
When two devices communicate with each other on
the bidirectional I2C bus, one is known as the master
device and one as the slave device. Both master and
slave can transmit and receive data, however, it is the
master device that has overall control of the bus. For
these devices, which only operates in slave mode,
there are two methods of transferring data on the I2C
bus, the slave transmit mode and the slave receive
mode.
This is the data shift select bit and is used to select
how the data is transferred, either MSB or LSB first.
Setting the bit high will select MSB first and low for
LSB first.
· CKEG and CKPOL
These two bits are used to setup the way that the
clock signal outputs and inputs data on the SPI bus.
These two bits must be configured before data transfer is executed otherwise an erroneous clock edge
may be generated. The CKPOL bit determines the
base condition of the clock line, if the bit is high then
the SCK line will be low when the clock is inactive.
When the CKPOL bit is low then the SCK line will be
high when the clock is inactive. The CKEG bit determines active clock edge type which depends upon the
condition of CKPOL.
Rev. 1.00
70
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
S IM E N = 1 , C S E N = 0 ( E x te r n a l P u ll- H ig h )
S C S
S IM E N , C S E N = 1
S C K (C K P O L = 1 , C K E G = 0 )
S C K (C K P O L = 0 , C K E G = 0 )
S C K (C K P O L = 1 , C K E G = 1 )
S C K (C K P O L = 0 , C K E G = 1 )
S D O
(C K E G = 0 )
D 7 /D 0
D 6 /D 1
D 5 /D 2
D 4 /D 3
D 3 /D 4
D 2 /D 5
D 1 /D 6
D 0 /D 7
S D O
(C K E G = 1 )
D 7 /D 0
D 6 /D 1
D 5 /D 2
D 4 /D 3
D 3 /D 4
D 2 /D 5
D 1 /D 6
D 0 /D 7
S D I D a ta C a p tu re
W r ite to S IM D R
SPI Master Mode Timing
S C S
S C K (C K P O L = 1 )
S C K (C K P O L = 0 )
S D O
D 7 /D 0
D 6 /D 1
D 5 /D 2
D 4 /D 3
D 3 /D 4
D 2 /D 5
D 1 /D 6
D 0 /D 7
D 2 /D 5
D 1 /D 6
D 0 /D 7
S D I D a ta C a p tu re
W r ite to S IM D R
( S D O n o t c h a n g e u n til fir s t S C K e d g e )
SPI Slave Mode Timing (CKEG=0)
S C S
S C K (C K P O L = 1 )
S C K (C K P O L = 0 )
S D O
D 7 /D 0
D 6 /D 1
D 5 /D 2
D 4 /D 3
D 3 /D 4
S D I D a ta C a p tu re
W r ite to S IM D R
( S D O c h a n g e a s s o o n a s w r itin g o c c u r ; S D O = flo a tin g if S C S = 1 )
N o te : F o r S P I s la v e m o d e , if S IM E N = 1 a n d C S E N = 0 , S P I is a lw a y s e n a b le d
a n d ig n o r e th e S C S le v e l.
SPI Slave Mode Timing (CKEG=1)
Rev. 1.00
71
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
A
S P I tra n s fe r
W r ite D a ta
in to S IM D R
C le a r W C O L
M a s te r
m a s te r o r
s la v e
S IM [2 :0 ]= 0 0 0 ,
0 0 1 ,0 1 0 ,0 1 1 o r 1 0 0
S la v e
Y
W C O L = 1 ?
N
S IM [2 :0 ]= 1 0 1
N
c o n fig u r e
C S E N a n d M L S
T r a n s m is s io n
c o m p le te d ?
(T R F = 1 ? )
Y
S IM E N = 1
R e a d D a ta
fro m S IM D R
A
C le a r T R F
T ra n s fe r
F in is h e d ?
N
Y
E N D
SPI Transfer Control Flowchart
Rev. 1.00
72
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
· I2C Registers
S T A R T s ig n a l
fro m M a s te r
There are three control registers associated with the
I2C bus, SIMCTL0, SIMCTL1 and SIMAR and one
data register, SIMDR. The SIMDR register, which is
shown in the above SPI section, is used to store the
data being transmitted and received on the I2C bus.
Before the microcontroller writes data to the I2C bus,
the actual data to be transmitted must be placed in the
2
SIMDR register. After the data is received from the I C
bus, the microcontroller can read it from the SIMDR
register. Any transmission or reception of data from
the I2C bus must be made via the SIMDR register.
Note that the SIMAR register also has the name
SIMCTL2 which is used by the SPI function. Bits
SIMIDLE , SIMEN and bits SIM0~SIM2 in register
SIMCTL0 are used by the I2C interface. The SIMCTL0
register is shown in the above SPI section.
S e n d s la v e a d d r e s s
a n d R /W b it fr o m M a s te r
A c k n o w le d g e
fr o m s la v e
S e n d d a ta b y te
fro m M a s te r
A c k n o w le d g e
fr o m s la v e
S T O P s ig n a l
fro m M a s te r
There are several configuration options associated
with the I2C interface. One of these is to enable the
function which selects the SIM pins rather than normal
I/O pins. Note that if the configuration option does not
select the SIM function then the SIMEN bit in the
SIMCTL0 register will have no effect. A configuration
option exists to allow a clock other than the system
clock to drive the I2C interface. Another configuration
option determines the debounce time of the I2C interface. This uses the internal clock to in effect add a
debounce time to the external clock to reduce the possibility of glitches on the clock line causing erroneous
operation. The debounce time, if selected, can be
chosen to be either 1 or 2 system clocks.
¨
SIMIDLE
2
The SIMIDLE bit is used to select if the I C interface
continues running when the device is in the IDLE
mode. Setting the bit high allows the I2C interface to
maintain operation when the device is in the Idle
mode. Clearing the bit to zero disables any I2C operations when in the Idle mode.
This SPI/I2C idle mode control bit is located at
CLKMOD register bit4.
¨
SIMEN
2
The SIMEN bit is the overall on/off control for the I C
interface. When the SIMEN bit is cleared to zero to
disable the I2C interface, the SDA and SCL lines will
be in a floating condition and the I2C operating current will be reduced to a minimum value. In this condition the pins can be used as SEG functions. When
the bit is high the I2C interface is enabled. The SIM
configuration option must have first enabled the SIM
interface for this bit to be effective. Note that when
the SIMENbit changes from low to high the contents
of the I2C control registers will be in an unknown
condition and should therefore be first initialised by
the application program.
¨
SIM0~SIM2
These bits setup the overall operating mode of the
SIM function. To select the I2C function, bits SIM2~
SIM0 should be set to the value 110.
Function
SIM
SIM function
SIM interface or SEG pins
I2C clock
I2C runs without internal clock
Disable/Enable
I2C debounce
No debounce, 1 system clock;
2 system clocks
2
I C Interface Configuration Options
D a ta B u s
I2C
H T X B it
S C L P in
S D A P in
M
X
S la v e A d d r e s s R e g is te r
(S IM A R )
A d d re s s
C o m p a ra to r
D ir e c tio n C o n tr o l
D a ta in L S B
D a ta O u t M S B
U
D a ta R e g is te r
(S IM D R )
S h ift R e g is te r
R e a d /w r ite S la v e
A d d re s s M a tc h
H A A S B it
S R W
I2C
In te rru p t
B it
E n a b le /D is a b le A c k n o w le d g e
T r a n s m it/R e c e iv e
C o n tr o l U n it
8 - b it D a ta C o m p le te
D e te c t S ta rt o r S to p
H C F B it
H B B B it
2
I C Block Diagram
Rev. 1.00
73
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
¨
¨
The SIMARregister is also used by the SPI interface but
has the name SIMCTL2.
The SIMARregister is the location where the 7-bit slave
address of the microcontroller is stored. Bits 1~7 of the
SIMAR register define the microcontroller slave address. Bit 0 is not defined. When a master device, which
is connected to the I2C bus, sends out an address,
which matches the slave address in the SIMARregister,
the microcontroller slave device will be selected. Note
that the SIMAR register is the same register as
SIMCTL2 which is used by the SPI interface.
SRW
The SRW bit is the Slave Read/Write bit. This bit determines whether the master device wishes to
2
transmit or receive data from the I C bus. When the
transmitted address and slave address match, that
is when the HAAS bit is set high, the device will
check the SRW bit to determine whether it should
be in transmit mode or receive mode. If the SRW bit
is high, the master is requesting to read data from
the bus, so the device should be in transmit mode.
When the SRW bit is zero, the master will write data
to the bus, therefore the device should be in receive
mode to read this data.
¨
TXAK
The TXAK flag is the transmit acknowledge flag. After the receipt of 8-bits of data, this bit will be transmitted to the bus on the 9th clock. To continue
receiving more data, this bit has to be reset to zero
before further data is received.
¨
HTX
The HTX flag is the transmit/receive mode bit. This
flag should be set high to set the transmit mode and
low for the receive mode.
¨
HBB
The HBB flag is the I2C busy flag. This flag will be
high when the I2C bus is busy which will occur when
a START signal is detected. The flag will be reset to
zero when the bus is free which will occur when a
STOP signal is detected.
¨
HASS
The HASS flag is the address match flag. This flag
is used to determine if the slave device address is
the same as the master transmit address. If the addresses match then this bit will be high, if there is no
match then the flag will be low.
¨
I2C Control Register - SIMAR
RXAK
The RXAK flag is the receive acknowledge flag.
When the RXAK bit has been reset to zero it means
that a correct acknowledge signal has been received at the 9th clock, after 8 bits of data have
been transmitted. When in the transmit mode, the
transmitter checks the RXAK bit to determine if the
receiver wishes to receive the next byte. The transmitter will therefore continue sending out data until
the RXAK bit is set high. When this occurs, the
transmitter will release the SDA line to allow the
master to send a STOP signal to release the bus.
I2C Bus Communication
Communication on the I2C bus requires four separate
steps, a START signal, a slave device address transmission, a data transmission and finally a STOP signal.
When a START signal is placed on the I2C bus, all devices on the bus will receive this signal and be notified of
the imminent arrival of data on the bus. The first seven
bits of the data will be the slave address with the first bit
being the MSB. If the address of the microcontroller
matches that of the transmitted address, the HAAS bit in
the SIMCTL1 register will be set and an I2C interrupt will
be generated. After entering the interrupt service routine, the microcontroller slave device must first check
the condition of the HAAS bit to determine whether the
interrupt source originates from an address match or
from the completion of an 8-bit data transfer. During a
data transfer, note that after the 7-bit slave address has
been transmitted, the following bit, which is the 8th bit, is
the read/write bit whose value will be placed in the SRW
bit. This bit will be checked by the microcontroller to determine whether to go into transmit or receive mode. Before any transfer of data to or from the I2C bus, the
microcontroller must initialise the bus, the following are
steps to achieve this:
Step 1
Write the slave address of the microcontroller to the I2C
bus address register SIMAR.
Step 2
Set the SIMEN bit in the SIMCTL0 register to ²1² to enable the I2C bus.
HCF
The HCF flag is the data transfer flag. This flag will
be zero when data is being transferred. Upon completion of an 8-bit data transfer the flag will go high
and an interrupt will be generated.
b 7
S A 6
Step 3
Set the ESIM bit of the interrupt control register to enable the I2C bus interrupt.
b 0
S A 5
S A 4
S A 3
S A 2
S A 1
S A 0
S IM A R
R e g is te r
N o t im p le m e n te d , r e a d a s " 0 "
I2C
d e v ic e s la v e a d d r e s s
I C Slave Address Register - SIMAR
2
Rev. 1.00
74
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
· Start Signal
S ta rt
The START signal can only be generated by the master device connected to the I2C bus and not by the
microcontroller, which is only a slave device. This
START signal will be detected by all devices con2
nected to the I C bus. When detected, this indicates
that the I2C bus is busy and therefore the HBB bit will
be set. A START condition occurs when a high to low
transition on the SDA line takes place when the SCL
line remains high.
W r ite S la v e
A d d re s s to S IM A R
S E T S IM [2 :0 ]= 1 1 0
S E T S IM E N
D is a b le
· Slave Address
The transmission of a START signal by the master will
be detected by all devices on the I2C bus. To determine which slave device the master wishes to communicate with, the address of the slave device will be
sent out immediately following the START signal. All
slave devices, after receiving this 7-bit address data,
will compare it with their own 7-bit slave address. If the
address sent out by the master matches the internal
address of the microcontroller slave device, then an
internal I2C bus interrupt signal will be generated. The
next bit following the address, which is the 8th bit, defines the read/write status and will be saved to the
SRW bit of the SIMCTL1 register. The device will then
transmit an acknowledge bit, which is a low level, as
the 9th bit. The microcontroller slave device will also
set the status flag HAAS when the addresses match.
As an I2C bus interrupt can come from two sources,
when the program enters the interrupt subroutine, the
HAAS bit should be examined to see whether the interrupt source has come from a matching slave address or from the completion of a data byte transfer.
When a slave address is matched, the device must be
placed in either the transmit mode and then write data
to the SIMDR register, or in the receive mode where it
must implement a dummy read from the SIMDR register to release the SCL line.
I2C B u s
In te rru p t= ?
E n a b le
C L R E H I
P o ll H IF to d e c id e
w h e n to g o to I2C B u s IS R
S E T E H I
W a it fo r In te r r u p t
G o to M a in P r o g r a m
G o to M a in P r o g r a m
I2C Bus Initialisation Flow Chart
SRW bit to determine if it is to be a transmitter or a receiver. If the SRW bit is high, the microcontroller slave
device should be setup to be a transmitter so the HTX
bit in the SIMCTL1 register should be set to ²1² if the
SRW bit is low then the microcontroller slave device
should be setup as a receiver and the HTX bit in the
SIMCTL1 register should be set to ²0².
· Data Byte
The transmitted data is 8-bits wide and is transmitted
after the slave device has acknowledged receipt of its
slave address. The order of serial bit transmission is
the MSB first and the LSB last. After receipt of 8-bits of
data, the receiver must transmit an acknowledge signal, level ²0², before it can receive the next data byte.
If the transmitter does not receive an acknowledge bit
signal from the receiver, then it will release the SDA
line and the master will send out a STOP signal to release control of the I2C bus. The corresponding data
will be stored in the SIMDR register. If setup as a
transmitter, the microcontroller slave device must first
write the data to be transmitted into the SIMDR register. If setup as a receiver, the microcontroller slave device must read the transmitted data from the SIMDR
register.
· SRW Bit
The SRW bit in the SIMCTL1 register defines whether
the microcontroller slave device wishes to read data
from the I2C bus or write data to the I2C bus. The
microcontroller should examine this bit to determine if
it is to be a transmitter or a receiver. If the SRW bit is
set to ²1² then this indicates that the master wishes to
re a d d a t a f r om t he I 2 C bus , t h e r ef o r e t h e
microcontroller slave device must be setup to send
data to the I2C bus as a transmitter. If the SRW bit is
²0² then this indicates that the master wishes to send
data to the I2C bus, therefore the microcontroller slave
device must be setup to read data from the I2C bus as
a receiver.
S C L
S D A
S ta r t b it
D a ta
s ta b le
D a ta
a llo w
c h a n g e
S to p b it
Data Timing Diagram
· Acknowledge Bit
· Receive Acknowledge Bit
After the master has transmitted a calling address,
any slave device on the I2C bus, whose own internal
address matches the calling address, must generate
an acknowledge signal. This acknowledge signal will
inform the master that a slave device has accepted its
calling address. If no acknowledge signal is received
by the master then a STOP signal must be transmitted
by the master to end the communication. When the
HAAS bit is high, the addresses have matched and
the microcontroller slave device must check the SRW
Rev. 1.00
When the receiver wishes to continue to receive the
next data byte, it must generate an acknowledge bit,
known as TXAK, on the 9th clock. The microcontroller
slave device, which is setup as a transmitter will check
the RXAK bit in the SIMCTL1 register to determine if it
is to send another data byte, if not then it will release
the SDA line and await the receipt of a STOP signal
from the master.
75
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
S C L
S R W
S la v e A d d r e s s
S ta rt
0
1
S D A
1
1
0
1
0
1
D a ta
S C L
1
0
0
1
A C K
0
A C K
0
1
0
S to p
0
S D A
S = S
S A =
S R =
M = S
D = D
A = A
P = S
S
ta rt (1
S la v e
S R W
la v e d
a ta (8
C K (R
to p (1
S A
b it)
A d d r e s s ( 7 b its )
b it ( 1 b it)
e v ic e s e n d a c k n o w le d g e b it ( 1 b it)
b its )
X A K b it fo r tr a n s m itte r , T X A K b it fo r r e c e iv e r 1 b it)
b it)
S R
M
D
A
D
A
S
S A
S R
M
D
A
D
A
P
2
I C Communication Timing Diagram
S ta rt
N o
N o
Y e s
H A A S = 1
?
Y e s
Y e s
H T X = 1
?
S R W = 1
?
N o
R e a d fro m
S IM D R
S E T H T X
C L R H T X
C L R T X A K
R E T I
W r ite to
S IM D R
D u m m y R e a d
F ro m S IM D R
R E T I
R E T I
Y e s
R X A K = 1
?
N o
C L R H T X
C L R T X A K
W r ite to
S IM D R
D u m m y R e a d
fro m S IM D R
R E T I
R E T I
I2C Bus ISR Flow Chart
Rev. 1.00
76
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
SPI Interface
The devices contain an independent SPI function. It is
important not to confuse this independent SPI function
with the additional one contained within the combined
SIM function, which is described in another section of
this datasheet.
high then the SCS1 line is active while if the bit is low
then the SCS line will be in a floating condition. The accompanying timing diagram depicts the basic timing
protocol of the SPI bus.
SPI Registers
The SPI interface is a full duplex serial data link, originally designed by Motorola, which allows multiple devices connected to the same SPI bus to communicate
with each other. The devices communicate using a master/slave technique where only the single master device
can initiate a data transfer. A simple four line signal bus
is used for all communication.
There are three registers for control of the SPI Interface.
These are the two control registers SPICTL0 and
SPICTL1 and the SBDR data register. The SPICTL0
register is used for the overall SPI enable/disable, master/slave selection and clock selection. The SPICTL1
register is used for SPI setup including, clock polarity,
edge selection as well as certain status flags. The
SBDR register is used for data storage. After Power on,
the contents of the SBDR register will be in an unknown
condition. Note that data written to the SBDR register
will only be written to the TXRX buffer, whereas data
read from the SBDR register will actual be read from the
register.
SPI Interface Communication
Four lines are used for each function. These are, SDI1
Serial Data Input, SDO1 Serial Data Output, SCK1 Serial Clock and SCS1 Slave Select. Note that the condition of the Slave Select line is conditioned by the CSEN1
bit in the SPICTL1 control register. If the CSEN1 bit is
· SPIDR Register
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Name
SPD7
SPD6
SPD5
SPD4
SPD3
SPD2
SPD1
SPD0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
POR
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
²x² unknown
Bit 7
SPD7~SPD0: SPI data
· SPICTL0 Register
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Name
SP12
SP11
SP10
¾
¾
¾
SPIEN
¾
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
¾
¾
¾
¾
¾
POR
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7~5
SPI2~SPI0: Master/Slave Clock Select
000: SPI master, fSYS/4
001: SPI master, fSYS/16
010: SPI master, fSYS/64
011: SPI master, fSUB
100: SPI master, timer 0 output/2 (PFD0)
101: SPI slave
Bit 4~2
unimplemented, read as ²0²
Bit 1
SPIEN: SPI Enable/Disable
0: disable
1: enable
Bit 0
unimplemented, read as ²0²
Rev. 1.00
77
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
· SPICTL1 Register
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Name
¾
¾
CKPOL1
CKEG1
MLS1
CSEN1
WCOL1
TRF1
R/W
¾
¾
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
POR
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7~6
unimplemented, read as ²0²
Bit 5
CKPOL1: Determines the base condition of the clock line
0: SCK1 line high when the clock is inactive
1: SCK1 line low when the clock is inactive
The CKPOL1 bit determines the base condition of the clock line, if the bit is high, then the SCK1
line will be low when the clock is inactive. When the CKPOL1 bit is low, then the SCK1 line will
be high when the clock is inactive.
Bit 4
CKEG1: Determines the SPI1 SCK1 active clock edge type
CKPOL1=0:
0: SCK1 has high base level with data capture on SCK1 rising edge
1: SCK1 has high base level with data capture on SCK1 falling edge
CKPOL1=1:
0: SCK1 has low base level with data capture on SCK1 falling edge
1: SCK1 has low base level with data capture on SCK1 rising edge
The CKEG1 and CKPOL1 bits are used to setup the way that the clock signal outputs and inputs
data on the SPI bus. These two bits must be configured before a data transfer is executed
otherwise an erroneous clock edge may be generated. The CKPOL1 bit determines the base
condition of the clock line, if the bit is high, then the SCK1 line will be low when the clock is
inactive. When the CKPOL1 bit is low, then the SCK1 line will be high when the clock is inactive.
The CKEG1 bit determines active clock edge type which depends upon the condition of
CKPOL1 bit.
Bit 3
MLS1: Determines the data shift order - MSB or LSB
0: LSB transmitted first
1: MSB transmitted first
Bit 2
CSEN1: SPI1 bus select
0: Disable - SPI1 bus is floating
1: Enable
Bit 1
WCOL1: Write collision flag
0: Collision free
1: Collision detected
This flag is set by the by the SPI1 bus and cleared by the application program. The flag will be
set to 1 if data is written to the SPIDR register (TXRX buffer) when a data is still being
transferred. Any such data write actions will be ignored in such cases.
Bit 0
TRF1: Transmit/Receive completion flag
0: Not complete
1: Data Transmission/Reception Complete
This flag will be set high when a data reception or transmission has completed. It must be
cleared using the application program and can be used to generate an interrupt.
Rev. 1.00
78
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
SPI Bus Enable/Disable
To enable the SPI bus, the SBEN bit should be set high,
then wait for data to be written to the SBDR (TXRX
buffer) register. For the Master Mode, after data has
been written to the SBDR (TXRX buffer) register then
transmission or reception will start automatically. When
all the data has been transferred, the TRF1 bit should be
set. For the Slave Mode, when clock pulses are received on SCK1, data in the TXRX buffer will be shifted
out or data on SDI1 will be shifted in. When the SPI bus
is disabled, SCK1, SDI1, SDO1 and SCS1 will be setup
as I/O pins.
¨
Step 4
For write operations: write the data to the SBDR
register, which will actually place the data into the
TXRX buffer. Then use the SCK1 and SCS1 lines to
output the data. Then goto to step 5. For read operations: the data transferred in on the SDI1 line will
be stored in the TXRX buffer until all the data has
been received at which point it will be latched into
the SBDR register.
¨
Step 5
Check the WCOL1 bit, if set high then a collision error has occurred so return to Step 4. If zero then go
to the following step.
¨
Step 6
Check the TRF1 bit or wait for an SPI serial bus interrupt.
¨
Step 7
Read data from the SBDR register.
¨
Step 8
Clear flag TRF1.
¨
Step 9
Goto step 4.
SPI Operation
The SPI is selected using the application program. All
communication is carried out using the 4-line interface
for both Master or Slave Mode. The CSEN1 bit in the
SPICTL1 register controls the SCSB line of the SPI interface. Setting this bit high, will enable the SPI interface
by allowing the SCS1 line to be active, which can then
be used to control the SPI interface. If the CSEN1 bit is
low, the SCS1 line will be in a floating condition and can
therefore not be used for control of the SPI interface.
When the CSEN1 bit is set high then SDI1 line will be
placed in a floating condition and the SDO1 line will be
high. If in the Master Mode, the SCK1 line will be either
high or low depending upon the clock polarity configuration option. If in the Slave Mode the SCK1 line will be in a
floating condition. If CSEN1 is low then the bus will be
disabled and SCS1, SDI1, SDO1 and SCK1 will all be in
a floating condition. The SPI function keeps running in
the IDLE mode - the SPI module can still operate after a
HALT instruction is executed. The CKEG1 and CKPOL1
bits must be setup before the SPI is enabled; otherwise
undesired clock edge may be generated.
· Slave Mode
¨
Step 1
Setup the SPI2~SPI0 bits to 101 to select the Slave
Mode.
¨
Step 2
Setup the SPIEN bit and setup the MLS1 bit to
choose if the data is MSB or LSB first, this must be
same as the Master device.
¨
Step 3
Setup the CSEN1 bit in the SPICTL1 control register to enable the SPI interface.
¨
Step 4
For write operations: write data to the SBDR register, which will actually place the data into the TXRX
register, then wait for the master clock and SCS1
signal. After this goto Step 5. For read operations:
the data transferred in on the SDI1 line will be
stored in the TXRX buffer until all the data has been
received at which point it will be latched into the
SBDR register.
¨
Step 5
Check the WCOL1 bit, if set high then a collision error has occurred so return to step 4. If equal to zero
then goto the following step.
Step 1
Setup the SPI2~SPI0 bits in the SPICTL0 control
register to select the Master Mode and the required
clock speed. Values of 000~101 can be selected.
¨
Step 6
Check the TRF1 bit or wait for an SPI interrupt.
¨
Step 7
Read data from the SBDR register.
Step 2
Setup the SPIEN bit and setup the MLS1 bit to
choose if the data is MSB or LSB first, this must be
same as the Slave device.
¨
Step 8
Clear TRF1
¨
Step 9
Goto step 4
In the Master Mode, the Master will always generate the
clock signal. The clock and data transmission will be initiated after data has been written to the SBDR register.
In the Slave Mode, the clock signal will be received from
an external master device for both data transmission or
reception. The following sequences show the order to
be followed for data transfer in both Master and Slave
Modes:
· Master Mode
¨
¨
¨
Step 3
Setup the CSEN1 bit in the SPICTL1 control register to enable the SPI interface.
Rev. 1.00
79
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
SPI Configuration Options
PCKEN in the SIMC0 register. The Peripheral Clock
function is controlled using the SIMC0 register. The
clock source for the Peripheral Clock Output can originate from either the Timer/Event Counter 0 or a divided
ratio of the internal fSYS clock. The PCKEN bit in the
SIMC0 register is the overall on/off control, setting
PCKEN bit to 1 enables the Peripheral Clock, setting
PCKEN bit to 0 disables it. The required division ratio of
the system clock is selected using the PCKP1 and
PCKP0 bits in the same register. If the device enters the
SLEEP Mode this will disable the Peripheral Clock output.
A configuration option is provided for an overall on/off
control for the SPI bus. Additional configuration options
are provided to enable operation of the WCOL1 bit
which is the write collision bit and the CSEN1 bus select
bit.
Peripheral Clock Output
The Peripheral Clock Output allows the device to supply
external hardware with a clock signal synchronised to
the microcontroller clock.
Peripheral Clock Operation
As the peripheral clock output pin, PCK, is shared with
an I/O line, the required pin function is chosen via
· SIMC0 Register
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Name
SIM2
SIM1
SIM0
PCKEN
PCKP1
PCKP0
SIMEN
¾
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
¾
POR
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
¾
Bit 7~5
SIM2, SIM1, SIM0: SIM operating mode control described in SIM section
Bit 4
PCKEN: PCK output pin control
0: Disable
1: Enable
Bit 3~2
PCKP1, PCKP0: select PCK output pin frequency
00: fSYS
01: fSYS/4
10: fSYS/8
11: TM0 CCRP match frequency/2
Bit 1
SIMEN: SIM control described in SIM section
Bit 0
unimplemented, read as ²0²
Rev. 1.00
80
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
Buzzer
Operating in a similar way to the Programmable Frequency Divider, the Buzzer function provides a means
of producing a variable frequency output, suitable for
applications such as Piezo-buzzer driving or other external circuits that require a precise frequency generator. The BZ and BZ pins form a complementary pair, and
are pin-shared with I/O pins, PB4 and PB5. A configuration option is used to select from one of three buzzer options. The first option is for both pins PB4 and PB5 to be
used as normal I/Os, the second option is for both pins
to be configured as BZ and BZ buzzer pins, the third option selects only the PB4 pin to be used as a BZ buzzer
pin with the PB5 pin retaining its normal I/O pin function.
Note that the BZ pin is the inverse of the BZ pin which together generate a differential output which can supply
more power to connected interfaces such as buzzers.
quency, can originate from three different sources, the
32768Hz oscillator, the 32K_INT oscillator or the System oscillator/4, the choice of which is determined by
the fS clock source configuration option. Note that the
buzzer frequency is controlled by configuration options,
which select both the source clock for the internal clock
fS and the internal division ratio. There are no internal
registers associated with the buzzer frequency.
If the configuration options have selected both pins PB4
and PB5 to function as a BZ and BZ complementary pair
of buzzer outputs, then for correct buzzer operation it is
essential that both pins must be setup as outputs by setting bits PBC4 and PBC5 of the PBC port control register to zero. The PB4 data bit in the PB data register must
also be set high to enable the buzzer outputs, if set low,
both pins PB4 and PB5 will remain low. In this way the
single bit PB4 of the PB register can be used as an
on/off control for both the BZ and BZ buzzer pin outputs.
Note that the PB5 data bit in the PB register has no control over the BZ buzzer pin PB5.
The buzzer is driven by the internal clock source, , which
then passes through a divider, the division ratio of which
is selected by configuration options to provide a range of
buzzer frequencies from fS/22 to fS/29. The clock source
that generates fS, which in turn controls the buzzer fre-
fS
Y S
/4
fS S o u rc e
C o n fig u r a tio n
O p tio n
3 2 7 6 8 H z
3 2 K _ IN T
fS
C o n fig u r a tio n O p tio n
D iv id e b y 2 2 ~ 2 9
B Z
B Z
Buzzer Function
PB4/PB5 Pin Function Control
PBC Register
PBC4
PBC Register
PBC5
PB Data Register
PB4
PB Data Register
PB5
Output
Function
0
0
1
x
PB4=BZ
PB5=BZ
0
0
0
x
PB4=²0²
PB5=²0²
0
1
1
x
PB4=BZ
PB5=input line
0
1
0
x
PB4=²0²
PB5=input line
1
0
x
D
PB4=input line
PB5=D
1
1
x
x
PB4=input line
PB4=input line
²x² stands for don¢t care
²D² stands for Data ²0² or ²1²
Rev. 1.00
81
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
Note that no matter what configuration option is chosen
for the buzzer, if the port control register has setup the
pin to function as an input, then this will override the configuration option selection and force the pin to always
behave as an input pin. This arrangement enables the
pin to be used as both a buzzer pin and as an input pin,
so regardless of the configuration option chosen; the actual function of the pin can be changed dynamically by
the application program by programming the appropriate port control register bit.
If configuration options have selected that only the PB4
pin is to function as a BZ buzzer pin, then the PB5 pin
can be used as a normal I/O pin. For the PB4 pin to function as a BZ buzzer pin, PB4 must be setup as an output
by setting bit PBC4 of the PBC port control register to
zero. The PB4 data bit in the PB data register must also
be set high to enable the buzzer output, if set low pin
PB4 will remain low. In this way the PB4 bit can be used
as an on/off control for the BZ buzzer pin PB4. If the
PBC4 bit of the PBC port control register is set high,
then pin PB4 can still be used as an input even though
the configuration option has configured it as a BZ buzzer
output.
In te r n a l C lo c k S o u r c e
P B 4 D a ta
B Z O u tp u t a t P B 4
P B 5 D a ta
B Z O u tp u t a t P B 5
Buzzer Output Pin Control
Note:
The above drawing shows the situation where both pins PB4 and PB5 are selected by configuration option to
be BZ and BZ buzzer pin outputs. The Port Control Register of both pins must have already been setup as output. The data setup on pin PB5 has no effect on the buzzer outputs.
Rev. 1.00
82
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
Interrupts
Interrupts are an important part of any microcontroller
system. When an external event or an internal function
such as a Timer/Event Counter or Time Base requires
microcontroller attention, their corresponding interrupt
will enforce a temporary suspension of the main program allowing the microcontroller to direct attention to
their respective needs.
Once an interrupt subroutine is serviced, all the other interrupts will be blocked, as the EMI bit will be cleared automatically. This will prevent any further interrupt
nesting from occurring. However, if other interrupt requests occur during this interval, although the interrupt
will not be immediately serviced, the request flag will still
be recorded. If an interrupt requires immediate servicing
while the program is already in another interrupt service
routine, the EMI bit should be set after entering the routine, to allow interrupt nesting. If the stack is full, the interrupt request will not be acknowledged, even if the
related interrupt is enabled, until the Stack Pointer is
decremented. If immediate service is desired, the stack
must be prevented from becoming full.
The devices contain a single external interrupt and multiple internal interrupts.
Interrupt Register
Overall interrupt control, which means interrupt enabling and request flag setting, is controlled by using
several registers, INTC0, INTC1, MFIC0 and MFIC1. By
controlling the appropriate enable bits in this registers
each individual interrupt can be enabled or disabled.
Also when an interrupt occurs, the corresponding request flag will be set by the microcontroller. The global
enable flag if cleared to zero will disable all interrupts.
When an interrupt request is generated it takes 2 or 3 instruction cycle before the program jumps to the interrupt
vector. If the device is in the Sleep or Idle Mode and is
woken up by an interrupt request then it will take 3 cycles before the program jumps to the interrupt vector.
Interrupt Operation
Main
Program
A range of internal and external events can all generate
an interrupt, by setting their correspponding request
flag, if their appropriate interrupt enable bit is set. When
this happens, the Program Counter, which stores the
address of the next instruction to be executed, will be
transferred onto the stack. The Program Counter will
then be loaded with a new address which will be the
value of the corresponding interrupt vector. The
microcontroller will then fetch its next instruction from
this interrupt vector. The instruction at this vector will
usually be a JMP statement which will jump to another
section of program which is known as the interrupt service routine. Here is located the code to control the appropriate interrupt. The interrupt service routine must be
terminated with a RETI instruction, which retrieves the
original Program Counter address from the stack and allows the microcontroller to continue with normal execution at the point where the interrupt occurred.
Interrupt Request or
Interrupt Flag Set by Instruction
N
Y
Main
Program
Automatically Disable Interrupt
Clear EMI & Request Flag
Wait for 2 ~ 3 Instruction Cycles
ISR Entry
RETI
(it will set EMI automatically)
The various interrupt enable bits, together with their associated request flags, are shown in the following diagram with their order of priority.
Rev. 1.00
Enable Bit Set ?
Interrupt Flow
83
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
A u to m a tic a lly C le a r e d b y IS R
e x c e p t
fo r A D F , T B F , R T F a n d T 2 F
M a n u a lly S e t o r C le a r e d b y S o ftw a r e
A u to m a tic a lly D is a b le d b y IS R
C a n b e E n a b le d M a n u a lly
P r io r ity
E x te rn a l In te rru p t
R e q u e s t F la g E IF 0
E E I0
E x te rn a l In te rru p t
R e q u e s t F la g E IF 1
E E I1
T im e r /E v e n t C o u n te r 0
In te r r u p t R e q u e s t F la g T 0 F
E T 0 I
T im e r /E v e n t C o u n te r 1
In te r r u p t R e q u e s t F la g T 1 F
E T 1 I
S P I/I2C
In te r r u p t R e q u e s t F la g S IM F
E S IM
M u lti- fu n c tio n
In te r r u p t R e q u e s t F la g M F F
E M F I
A /D C o n v e rte r
In te r r u p t R e q u e s t F la g A D F
E A D I
R e a l T im e C lo c k
In te r r u p t R e q u e s t F la g R T F
E R T I
T im e B a s e
In te r r u p t R e q u e s t F la g T B F
E T B I
E x te r n a l P e r ip h e r a l
In te r r u p t R e q u e s t F la g P E F
E P I
T im e r /E v e n t C o u n te r 2
In te r r u p t R e q u e s t F la g T 2 F
E T 2 I
T im e r /E v e n t C o u n te r 3
In te r r u p t R e q u e s t F la g T 3 F
E T 3 I
S P I
In te r r u p t R e q u e s t F la g S P IF
E S P I
E M I
H ig h
In te rru p t
P o llin g
L o w
Interrupt Structure
Rev. 1.00
84
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
Interrupt Priority
HT56R25/HT56R26
Interrupts, occurring in the interval between the rising
edges of two consecutive T2 pulses, will be serviced on
the latter of the two T2 pulses, if the corresponding interrupts are enabled. In case of simultaneous requests, the
following table shows the priority that is applied. These
can be masked by resetting the EMI bit.
A/D Converter Interrupt
6
18H
External Peripheral Interrupt
6
18H
SPI1
6
18H
Timer/Event Counter 2 Overflow
6
18H
Timer/Event Counter 3 Overflow
6
18H
HT56R22
Interrupt Source
Priority
Vector
External Interrupt 0
1
04H
External Interrupt 1
2
08H
Timer/Event Counter 0 Overflow
3
0CH
Timer/Event Counter 1 Overflow
4
10H
SPI/I C Interrupt
5
14H
Time Base Interrupt
6
18H
RTC Interrupt
6
18H
A/D Converter Interrupt
6
18H
External Peripheral Interrupt
6
18H
SPI Interrupt
6
18H
Priority
Vector
External Interrupt 0
1
04H
External Interrupt 1
2
08H
Timer/Event Counter 0 Overflow
3
0CH
In cases where both external and internal interrupts are
enabled and where an external and internal interrupt occurs simultaneously, the external interrupt will always
have priority and will therefore be serviced first. Suitable
masking of the individual interrupts using the interrupt
registers can prevent simultaneous occurrences.
Interrupt Operation
2
When the conditions for an interrupt event occur, such
as a Timer/Event Counter overflow, or A/D conversion
completion etc, the relevant interrupt request flag will be
set. Whether the request flag actually generates a program jump to the relevant interrupt vector is determined
by the condition of the interrupt enable bit. If the enable
bit is set high then the program will jump to its relevant
vector; if the enable bit is zero then although the interrupt request flag is set an actual interrupt will not be generated and the program will not jump to the relevant
interrupt vector. The global interrupt enable bit, if
cleared to zero, will disable all interrupts.
HT56R23/HT56R24
Interrupt Source
Timer/Event Counter 1 Overflow
4
10H
SPI/I2C Interrupt
5
14H
Time Base Interrupt
6
18H
RTC Interrupt
6
18H
A/D Converter Interrupt
6
18H
External Peripheral Interrupt
6
18H
SPI1
6
18H
Timer/Event Counter 2 Overflow
6
18H
When an interrupt is generated, the Program Counter,
which stores the address of the next instruction to be executed, will be transferred onto the stack. The Program
Counter will then be loaded with a new address which
will be the value of the corresponding interrupt vector.
The microcontroller will then fetch its next instruction
from this interrupt vector. The instruction at this vector
will usually be a JMP which will jump to another section
of program which is known as the interrupt service routine. Here is located the code to control the appropriate
interrupt. The interrupt service routine must be terminated with a RETI, which retrieves the original Program
Counter address from the stack and allows the
microcontroller to continue with normal execution at the
point where the interrupt occurred. The various interrupt
enable bits, together with their associated request flags,
are shown in the accompanying diagrams with their order of priority. Some interrupt sources have their own individual vector while others share the same
multi-function interrupt vector. Once an interrupt subroutine is serviced, all the other interrupts will be
blocked, as the global interrupt enable bit, EMI bit will be
cleared automatically. This will prevent any further interrupt nesting from occurring. However, if other interrupt
requests occur during this interval, although the interrupt will not be immediately serviced, the request flag
will still be recorded.
HT56R25/HT56R26
Interrupt Source
Priority
Vector
External Interrupt 0
1
04H
External Interrupt 1
2
08H
Timer/Event Counter 0 Overflow
3
0CH
Timer/Event Counter 1 Overflow
4
10H
SPI/I C Interrupt
5
14H
Time Base Interrupt
6
18H
RTC Interrupt
6
18H
2
Rev. 1.00
85
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
If an interrupt requires immediate servicing while the
program is already in another interrupt service routine,
the EMI bit should be set after entering the routine, to allow interrupt nesting. If the stack is full, the interrupt request will not be acknowledged, even if the related
interrupt is enabled, until the Stack Pointer is decremented. If immediate service is desired, the stack must
be prevented from becoming full. In case of simultaneous requests, the accompanying diagram shows the
priority that is applied. All of the interrupt request flags
when set will wake-up the device if it is in SLEEP or
IDLE Mode, however to prevent a wake-up from occurring the corresponding flag should be set before the device is in SLEEP or IDLE Mode.
a transition, whose type is chosen by the edge select bit,
appears on the INT0 or INT1 pin. The external interrupt
pins are pin-shared with the I/O pins PA4 and PA6 and
can only be configured as external interrupt pins if their
corresponding external interrupt enable bit in the INTC0
register has been set. The pin must also be setup as an
input by setting the corresponding PAC.4 and PAC.6
bits in the port control register. When the interrupt is enabled, the stack is not full and the correct transition type
appears on the external interrupt pin, a subroutine call to
the external interrupt vector at location 04H or 08H, will
take place. When the interrupt is serviced, the external
interrupt request flags, EIF0 or EIF1, will be automatically reset and the EMI bit will be automatically cleared
to disable other interrupts. Note that any pull-high resistor selections on this pin will remain valid even if the pin
is used as an external interrupt input.
External Interrupt
For an external interrupt to occur, the global interrupt enable bit, EMI, and external interrupt enable bits, EEI0
and EEI1, must first be set. Additionally the correct interrupt edge type must be selected using the INTEDGE
register to enable the external interrupt function and to
choose the trigger edge type. An actual external interrupt will take place when the external interrupt request
flag, EIF0 or EIF1, is set, a situation that will occur when
The INTEDGE register is used to select the type of active
edge that will trigger the external interrupt. A choice of either rising and falling edge types can be chosen along
with an option to allow both edge types to trigger an external interrupt. Note that the INTEDGE register can also
be used to disable the external interrupt function.
· INTEDGE Register - All Devices
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Name
¾
¾
¾
¾
INT1S1
INT1S0
INT0S1
INT0S0
R/W
¾
¾
¾
¾
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
POR
¾
¾
¾
¾
0
0
0
0
Bit 7~4
unimplemented, read as ²0²
Bit 3~2
INT1S1, INT1S0: interrupt edge control for INT1 pin
00: disable
01: rising edge
10: falling edge
11: rising and falling edges
Bit 1~0
INT0S1, INT0S0: interrupt edge control for INT0 pin
00: disable
01: rising edge
10: falling edge
11: rising and falling edges
Rev. 1.00
86
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
· INTC0 Register - All Devices
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Name
¾
T0F
INT1F
INT0F
T0E
INT1E
INT0E
EMI
R/W
¾
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
POR
¾
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
unimplemented, read as ²0²
Bit 6
T0F: Timer/Event Counter 0 interrupt request flag
0: inactive
1: active
Bit 5
INT1F: External interrupt 1 request flag
0: inactive
1: active
Bit 4
INT0F: External interrupt 0 request flag
0: inactive
1: active
Bit 3
T0E: Timer/Event Counter 0 interrupt enable
0: disable
1: enable
Bit 2
INT1E: external interrupt 1 enable
0: disable
1: enable
Bit 1
INT0E: external interrupt 0 enable
0: disable
1: enable
Bit 0
EMI: Master interrupt global enable
0: disable
1: enable
· INTC1 Register - All Devices
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Name
¾
MFF
SIMF
T1F
¾
MFE
SIME
T1E
R/W
¾
R/W
R/W
R/W
¾
R/W
R/W
R/W
POR
¾
0
0
0
¾
0
0
0
Bit 7
unimplemented, read as ²0²
Bit 6
MFF: Multi-function interrupt request flag
1: active
0: inactive
Bit 5
SIMF: SPI/I2C interrupt request flag
1: active
0: inactive
Bit 4
T1F: Timer/Event Counter 1 interrupt request flag
0: inactive
1: active
Bit 3
unimplemented, read as ²0²
Bit 2
MFE: Multi-function interrupt enable
0: disable
1: enable
Bit 1
SIME: Serial Interface Module interrupt enable
0: disable
1: enable
Bit 0
T1E: Timer/Event Counter 1 interrupt enable
0: disable
1: enable
Rev. 1.00
87
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
· MFIC0 Register - All devices
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Name
XPF
TBF
RTF
ADF
XPE
TBE
RTE
ADE
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
POR
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
3
2
1
0
Bit 7
XPF: External Peripheral Interrupt Request Flag
0: inactive
1: active
Bit 6
TBF: Time Base Interrupt Request Flag
0: inactive
1: active
Bit 5
RTF: Real Time Clock Interrupt Request Flag
0: inactive
1: active
Bit 4
ADF: A/D Converter Interrupt Request Flag
0: inactive
1: active
Bit 3
XPE: External Peripheral Interrupt Enable
0: enable
1: disable
Bit 2
TBE: Time Base Interrupt Enable
0: enable
1: disable
Bit 1
RTE: Real Time Clock Interrupt Control
0: enable
1: disable
Bit 0
ADE: A/D Converter Interrupt Control
0: enable
1: disable
· MFIC1 Register - HT56R22
Bit
7
6
5
4
Name
¾
¾
¾
SPIF
¾
¾
¾
SPIE
R/W
¾
¾
¾
R/W
¾
¾
¾
R/W
POR
¾
¾
¾
0
¾
¾
¾
0
Bit 7~5
unimplemented, read as ²0²
Bit 4
SPIF: SPI Interface Interrupt Request Flag
0: inactive
1: active
Bit 3~1
unimplemented, read as ²0²
Bit 0
SPIE: SPI Interface Interrupt Control
0: enable
1: disable
Rev. 1.00
88
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
· MFIC1 Register - HT56R23/HT56R24
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
Name
¾
¾
T2F
SPIF
¾
¾
R/W
¾
¾
R/W
R/W
¾
¾
POR
¾
¾
0
0
¾
¾
0
0
3
2
1
0
T3E
T2E
SPIE
Bit 7~6
unimplemented, read as ²0²
Bit 5
T2F: Timer/Event Counter 2 Interrupt Request Flag
0: inactive
1: active
Bit 4
SPIF: SPI Interface Interrupt Request Flag
0: inactive
1: active
Bit 3~2
unimplemented, read as ²0²
Bit 1
T2E: Timer/Event Counter 2 Interrupt Control
0: enable
1: disable
Bit 0
SPIE: SPI Interface Interrupt Control
0: enable
1: disable
1
0
SPIE
R/W
· MFIC1 Register - HT56R25/HT56R26
Bit
7
6
5
4
Name
¾
T3F
R/W
¾
T2F
SSPIFPIF
¾
R/W
R/W
¾
R/W
POR
¾
0
0
¾
0
Bit 7
unimplemented, read as ²0²
Bit 6
T3F: Timer/Event Counter 2 Interrupt Request Flag
0: inactive
1: active
Bit 5
T2F: Timer/Event Counter 2 Interrupt Request Flag
0: inactive
1: active
Bit 4
SPIF: SPI Interface Interrupt Request Flag
0: inactive
1: active
Bit 3
unimplemented, read as ²0²
Bit 2
T3E: Timer/Event Counter 2 Interrupt Control
0: enable
1: disable
Bit 1
T2E: Timer/Event Counter 2 Interrupt Control
0: enable
1: disable
Bit 0
SPIE: SPI Interface Interrupt Control
0: enable
1: disable
Rev. 1.00
89
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
Timer/Event Counter Interrupt
Serial Interface Module Interrupt
For a Timer/Event Counter interrupt to occur, the global
interrupt enable bit, EMI, and the corresponding timer
interrupt enable bit, TnE, must first be set. An actual
Timer/Event Counter interrupt will take place when the
Timer/Event Counter request flag, TnF, is set, a situation
that will occur when the relevant Timer/Event Counter
overflows. When the interrupt is enabled, the stack is
not full and a Timer/Event Counter n overflow occurs, a
subroutine call to the relevant timer interrupt vector, will
take place. When the interrupt is serviced, the timer interrupt request flag, TnF, will be automatically reset and
the EMI bit will be automatically cleared to disable other
interrupts.
The Serial Interface Module Interrupt, also known as the
SIM interrupt, is contained within the Multi-function Interrupt. A SIM Interrupt request will take place when the
SIM Interrupt request flag, SIMF, is set, which occurs
when a byte of data has been received or transmitted by
the SIM interface. To allow the program to branch to its
respective interrupt vector address, the global interrupt
enable bit, EMI, and the Serial Interface Interrupt enable
bit, SIME, and Multi-function interrupt enable bits, must
first be set. When the interrupt is enabled, the stack is
not full and a byte of data has been transmitted or received by the SIM interface, a subroutine call to the
Multi-function Interrupt vector, will take place. When the
Serial Interface Interrupt is serviced, the EMI bit will be
automatically cleared to disable other interrupts, however only the Multi-function interrupt request flag will be
also automatically cleared. As the SIMF flag will not be
automatically cleared, it has to be cleared by the application program.
Time Base Interrupt
For a time base interrupt to occur the global interrupt enable bit EMI and the corresponding interrupt enable bit
TBE, must first be set. An actual Time Base interrupt will
take place when the time base request flag TBF is set, a
situation that will occur when the Time Base overflows.
When the interrupt is enabled, the stack is not full and a
time base overflow occurs a subroutine call to time base
vector will take place. When the interrupt is serviced, the
time base interrupt flag. TBF will be automatically reset
and the EMI bit will be automatically cleared to disable
other interrupts.
External Peripheral Interrupt
The External Peripheral Interrupt operates in a similar
way to the external interrupt and is contained within the
Multi-function Interrupt. A Peripheral Interrupt request
will take place when the External Peripheral Interrupt re
quest flag, XPF, is set, which occurs when a negative
edge transition appears on the PINT pin. To allow the
program to branch to its respective interrupt vector address, the global interrupt enable bit, EMI, external peripheral interrupt enable bit, XPE, and Multi-function
interrupt enable bit, must first be set. When the interrupt is enabled, the stack is not full and a negative transition appears on the External Peripheral Interrupt pin,
a subroutine call to the Multi-function Interrupt, will
take place. When the External Peripheral Interrupt is
serviced, the EMI bit will be automatically cleared to disable other interrupts, however only the Multi-function interrupt request flag will be also automatically cleared.
As the XPF flag will not be automatically cleared, it has
to be cleared by the application program. The external
peripheral interrupt pin is pin-shared with several other
pins with different functions. It must therefore be properly configured to enable it to operate as an External Peripheral Interrupt pin.
A/D Converter Interrupt
The A/D Converter Interrupt is controlled by the termination of an A/D conversion process. An A/D Converter Interrupt request will take place when the A/D Converter
Interrupt request flag, ADF, is set, which occurs when
the A/D conversion process finishes. To allow the program to branch to its respective interrupt vector address, the global interrupt enable bit, EMI, and A/D
Interrupt enable bit, ADE, and Multi-function interrupt
enable bits, must first be set.must first be set. When the
interrupt is enabled, the stack is not full and the A/D conversion process has ended, a subroutine call to the
Multi-function Interrupt vector, will take place. When the
interrupt is serviced, the EMI bit will be automatically
cleared to disable other interrupts, however only the
Multi-function interrupt request flag will be also automatically cleared. As the ADF flag will not be automatically
cleared, it has to be cleared by the application program.
Rev. 1.00
90
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
Multi-function Interrupt
LCD SCOM Function
Within these devices there is a Multi-function interrupt.
Unlike the other independent interrupts, these interrupts have no independent source, but rather are
formed from other existing interrupt sources.
The devices have the capability of driving external LCD
panels. The common pins for LCD driving, SCOM0~
SCOM3, are pin shared with certain pin on the PB0~
PB3 port. The LCD signals (COM and SEG) are generated using the application program.
A Multi-function interrupt request will take place when
the Multi-function interrupt request flag, MFF is set.
The Multi-function interrupt flag will be set when any of
their included functions generate an interrupt request
flag. To allow the program to branch to its respective interrupt vector address, when the Multi-function interrupt is enabled and the stack is not full, and either one of
the interrupts contained the Multi-function interrupt occurs, a subroutine call to the Multi-function interrupt vector will take place. When the interrupt is serviced, the
Multi-Function request flag, will be automatically reset
and the EMI bit will be automatically cleared to disable
other interrupts.
LCD Operation
An external LCD panel can be driven using this device
by configuring the PB0~PB3 pins as common pins and
using other output ports lines as segment pins. The LCD
driver function is controlled using the SCOMC register
which in addition to controlling the overall on/off function
also controls the bias voltage setup function. This enables the LCD COM driver to generate the necessary
VDD/2 voltage levels for LCD 1/2 bias operation.
The SCOMEN bit in the SCOMC register is the overall
master control for the LCD Driver, however this bit is
used in conjunction with the COMnEN bits to select
which Port B pins are used for LCD driving. Note that the
Port Control register does not need to first setup the pins
as outputs to enable the LCD driver operation.
However, it must be noted that, although the
Multi-function Interrupt flag will be automatically reset
when the interrupt is serviced, the request flag from the
original source of the Multi-function interrupt, will not be
automatically reset and must be manually reset by the
application program.
V
D D
S C O M
Programming Considerations
V
By disabling the interrupt enable bits, a requested interrupt can be prevented from being serviced, however,
once an interrupt request flag is set, it will remain in this
condition in the interrupt register until the corresponding
interrupt is serviced or until the request flag is cleared by
a software instruction.
D D
o p e r a tin g c u r r e n t
/2
S C O M 0 ~
S C O M 3
C O M n E N
S C O M E N
It is recommended that programs do not use the ²CALL
subroutine² instruction within the interrupt subroutine.
Interrupts often occur in an unpredictable manner or
need to be serviced immediately in some applications. If
only one stack is left and the interrupt is not well controlled, the original control sequence will be damaged
once a ²CALL subroutine² is executed in the interrupt
subroutine.
LCD COM Bias
All of these interrupts have the capability of waking up
the processor when in the Idle/Sleep Mode.
SCOMEN
COMnEN
Pin Function
O/P Level
0
X
I/O
0 or 1
1
0
I/O
0 or 1
1
1
SCOMN
VDD/2
Output Control
Only the Program Counter is pushed onto the stack. If
the contents of the register or status register are altered
by the interrupt service program, which may corrupt the
desired control sequence, then the contents should be
saved in advance.
Rev. 1.00
91
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
LCD Bias Control
The LCD COM driver enables a range of selections to be provided to suit the requirement of the LCD panel which is being used. The bias resistor choice is implemented using the ISEL1 and ISEL0 bits in the SCOMC register.
· SCOMC Register
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Name
¾
¾
ISEL
SCOMEN
COM3EN
COM2EN
COM1EN
COM0EN
R/W
¾
¾
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
POR
¾
¾
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7, 6
unimplemented, read as ²0²
Bit 5
ISEL: SCOM operating current selection (VDD=5V)
0: 25mA
1: 50mA
Bit 4
SCOMEN: SCOM module on/off control
0: disable
1: enable
SCOMn can be enable by COMnEN if SCOMEN=1
Bit 3
COM3EN: PB3 or SCOM3 selection
0: GPIO
1: SCOM3
Bit 2
COM2EN: PB2 or SCOM2 selection
0: GPIO
1: SCOM2
Bit 1
COM1EN: PB1 or SCOM1 selection
0: GPIO
1: SCOM1
Bit 0
COM0EN: PB0 or SCOM0 selection
0: GPIO
1: SCOM0
Rev. 1.00
92
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
Digital to Analog Converter - DAC
All devices include a 12-bit Digital to Analog Converter
function. This function allows digital data contained in
the device to generate audio signals.
DA0~DA3. An additional control register, DACTRL, provides overall DAC on/off control in addition to a 3-bit
8-level volume control. The DAC output is channeled to
pin AUD which is pin-shared with I/O pin PB5. When the
DAC is enabled by setting the DACEN pin high, then the
original I/O function will be disabled, along with any
pull-high resistor options.
Operation
The data to be converted is stored in two registers DAL
and DAH. The DAH register stores the highest 8-bits,
DA4~DA11, while DAL stores the lowest 4-bits,
· DACH Register
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Name
DA11
DA10
DA9
DA8
DA7
DA6
DA5
DA4
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
POR
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bits 7~0
DA11~DA0: Audio Output DAC high byte bits
· DACL Register
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Name
DA3
DA2
DA1
DA0
¾
¾
¾
¾
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
¾
¾
¾
¾
POR
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bits 7~4
DA3~DA0: Audio Output DAC low bits
Bits 3~0
unimplemented, read as ²0²
· DACTL Register
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Name
VOL2
VOL1
VOL0
¾
¾
¾
¾
DACEN
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
¾
¾
¾
¾
R/W
POR
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bits 7~5
VOL2~VOL0: Audio Volume Control
Bits 4~1
unimplemented, read as ²0²
Bit 0
DACEN: DAC On/Off Control
0: Off
1: On
The DAC output is channeled to pin AUD which is pin-shared with I/O pin PB5. When the DAC is enabled by setting the
DACEN pin high, then the original I/O function will be disabled, along with any pull-high resistor options. The DAC output reference voltage is the power supply voltage VDD.
Rev. 1.00
93
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
Configuration Options
Configuration options refer to certain options within the MCU that are programmed into the OTP Program Memory device during the programming process. During the development process, these options are selected using the HT-IDE
software development tools. As these options are programmed into the device using the hardware programming tools,
once they are selected they cannot be changed later by the application software. All options must be defined for proper
system function, the details of which are shown in the table.
No.
Options
Oscillator Options
1
High Oscillator type selection - fM
1. External Crystal Oscillator
2. External RC Oscillator
3. Externally supplied clock - internal filter on
4. Externally supplied clock - internal filter off
2
fSUB clock selection:
1. 32768Hz External Oscillator
2. 32K_INT Internal Oscillator
3
fS clock selection: fSUB or fSYS/4
4
XTAL mode selection: 455KHz or 1M~12MHz
5
32768Hz Crystal: enable or disable
PFD Options
6
PA3: normal I/O or PFD output
7
PFD clock selection: Timer/Event Counter 0 or Timer/Event Counter 1
Buzzer Options
8
PA0/PA1: normal I/O or BZ/BZ or PA0=BZ and PA1 as normal I/O
9
Buzzer frequency: fS/22, fS/23, fS/24, fS/25, fS/26, fS/27, fS/28, fS/29
Time Base Option
10
Time base time-out period: 212/fS, 213/fS, 214/fS, 215/fS,
LCD Option
11
LCD type: R or C - HT56R66 only
Watchdog Options
12
Watchdog Timer function: enable or disable
13
CLRWDT instructions: 1 or 2 instructions
14
WDT time-out period: 212/fS~213/fS, 213/fS~214/fS, 214/fS~215/fS, 215/fS~216/fS
LVD/LVR Options
15
LVD function: enable or disable
16
LVR function: enable or disable
17
LVR/LVD voltage: 2.1V/2.2V or 3.15V/3.3V or 4.2V/4.4V
SPI Options
18
SIM pin enable/disable
19
SPI_WCOL: enable/disable
20
SPI_CSEN: enable/disable, used to enable/disable (1/0) software CSEN function
2
I C Option
21
Rev. 1.00
I2C debounce Time: no debounce, 1 system clock debounce, 2 system clock debounce
94
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
No.
Options
PINTB Option
22
External peripheral interrupt or Segment function
Timer/Event Counter and External Interrupt Pins Filter Option
23
Interrupt and Timer/Event Counter input pins internal filter On/Off control - applies to all pins
Lock Options
24
Lock All
25
Partial Lock
Application Circuits
HT56R22
V
D D
0 .0 1 m F
0 .1 m F
V D D
R e s e t
C ir c u it
1 0 k W ~
1 0 0 k W
1 N 4 1 4 8
0 .1 ~ 1 m F
3 0 0 W
R E S /P C 7
V S S
O S C
C ir c u it
O S C 1
O S C 2
S e e O s c illa to r
S e c tio n
O S C
C ir c u it
P B 0 /S C
P B
P B 2
P B
K /S
1 /S
/P C
3 /P
C L
C S
L K
IN T
/A N
/A N
/A N
/A N
/A N
/A N
/A N
/A N
O M
O M
O M
O M
P B 4 /B
P B 5 /B Z /A U
0
1
3
/C
/C
/C
/C
6
4
2
5
7
0
D
1
Z
3
2
X T 1
P C 0 ~ P C 3
X T 2
P D 0 /P W M 0 /S D I/S D A
P D 1 /P W M 1 /S D O
P D 2 /P W M 2 /S C S 1
S e e O s c illa to r
S e c tio n
Rev. 1.00
P A
P A
P A
P A 5 /T C 0
P A 6 /IN T
P A 7 /T C 1
P A 0
P A 1
2 /T C 0
3 /P F D
4 /IN T 0
/S D O 1
1 /S D I1
/S C K 1
95
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
Instruction Set
subtract instruction mnemonics to enable the necessary
arithmetic to be carried out. Care must be taken to ensure correct handling of carry and borrow data when results exceed 255 for addition and less than 0 for
subtraction. The increment and decrement instructions
INC, INCA, DEC and DECA provide a simple means of
increasing or decreasing by a value of one of the values
in the destination specified.
Introduction
C e n t ra l t o t he s uc c es s f ul oper a t i on o f a n y
microcontroller is its instruction set, which is a set of program instruction codes that directs the microcontroller to
perform certain operations. In the case of Holtek
microcontrollers, a comprehensive and flexible set of
over 60 instructions is provided to enable programmers
to implement their application with the minimum of programming overheads.
Logical and Rotate Operations
For easier understanding of the various instruction
codes, they have been subdivided into several functional groupings.
The standard logical operations such as AND, OR, XOR
and CPL all have their own instruction within the Holtek
microcontroller instruction set. As with the case of most
instructions involving data manipulation, data must pass
through the Accumulator which may involve additional
programming steps. In all logical data operations, the
zero flag may be set if the result of the operation is zero.
Another form of logical data manipulation comes from
the rotate instructions such as RR, RL, RRC and RLC
which provide a simple means of rotating one bit right or
left. Different rotate instructions exist depending on program requirements. Rotate instructions are useful for
serial port programming applications where data can be
rotated from an internal register into the Carry bit from
where it can be examined and the necessary serial bit
set high or low. Another application where rotate data
operations are used is to implement multiplication and
division calculations.
Instruction Timing
Most instructions are implemented within one instruction cycle. The exceptions to this are branch, call, or table read instructions where two instruction cycles are
required. One instruction cycle is equal to 4 system
clock cycles, therefore in the case of an 8MHz system
oscillator, most instructions would be implemented
within 0.5ms and branch or call instructions would be implemented within 1ms. Although instructions which require one more cycle to implement are generally limited
to the JMP, CALL, RET, RETI and table read instructions, it is important to realize that any other instructions
which involve manipulation of the Program Counter Low
register or PCL will also take one more cycle to implement. As instructions which change the contents of the
PCL will imply a direct jump to that new address, one
more cycle will be required. Examples of such instructions would be ²CLR PCL² or ²MOV PCL, A². For the
case of skip instructions, it must be noted that if the result of the comparison involves a skip operation then
this will also take one more cycle, if no skip is involved
then only one cycle is required.
Branches and Control Transfer
Program branching takes the form of either jumps to
specified locations using the JMP instruction or to a subroutine using the CALL instruction. They differ in the
sense that in the case of a subroutine call, the program
must return to the instruction immediately when the subroutine has been carried out. This is done by placing a
return instruction RET in the subroutine which will cause
the program to jump back to the address right after the
CALL instruction. In the case of a JMP instruction, the
program simply jumps to the desired location. There is
no requirement to jump back to the original jumping off
point as in the case of the CALL instruction. One special
and extremely useful set of branch instructions are the
conditional branches. Here a decision is first made regarding the condition of a certain data memory or individual bits. Depending upon the conditions, the program
will continue with the next instruction or skip over it and
jump to the following instruction. These instructions are
the key to decision making and branching within the program perhaps determined by the condition of certain input switches or by the condition of internal data bits.
Moving and Transferring Data
The transfer of data within the microcontroller program
is one of the most frequently used operations. Making
use of three kinds of MOV instructions, data can be
transferred from registers to the Accumulator and
vice-versa as well as being able to move specific immediate data directly into the Accumulator. One of the most
important data transfer applications is to receive data
from the input ports and transfer data to the output ports.
Arithmetic Operations
The ability to perform certain arithmetic operations and
data manipulation is a necessary feature of most
microcontroller applications. Within the Holtek
microcontroller instruction set are a range of add and
Rev. 1.00
96
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
Bit Operations
Other Operations
The ability to provide single bit operations on Data Memory is an extremely flexible feature of all Holtek
microcontrollers. This feature is especially useful for
output port bit programming where individual bits or port
pins can be directly set high or low using either the ²SET
[m].i² or ²CLR [m].i² instructions respectively. The feature removes the need for programmers to first read the
8-bit output port, manipulate the input data to ensure
that other bits are not changed and then output the port
with the correct new data. This read-modify-write process is taken care of automatically when these bit operation instructions are used.
In addition to the above functional instructions, a range
of other instructions also exist such as the ²HALT² instruction for Power-down operations and instructions to
control the operation of the Watchdog Timer for reliable
program operations under extreme electric or electromagnetic environments. For their relevant operations,
refer to the functional related sections.
Instruction Set Summary
The following table depicts a summary of the instruction
set categorised according to function and can be consulted as a basic instruction reference using the following listed conventions.
Table Read Operations
Table conventions:
Data storage is normally implemented by using registers. However, when working with large amounts of
fixed data, the volume involved often makes it inconvenient to store the fixed data in the Data Memory. To overcome this problem, Holtek microcontrollers allow an
area of Program Memory to be setup as a table where
data can be directly stored. A set of easy to use instructions provides the means by which this fixed data can be
referenced and retrieved from the Program Memory.
Mnemonic
x: Bits immediate data
m: Data Memory address
A: Accumulator
i: 0~7 number of bits
addr: Program memory address
Description
Cycles
Flag Affected
1
1Note
1
1
1Note
1
1
1Note
1
1Note
1Note
Z, C, AC, OV
Z, C, AC, OV
Z, C, AC, OV
Z, C, AC, OV
Z, C, AC, OV
Z, C, AC, OV
Z, C, AC, OV
Z, C, AC, OV
Z, C, AC, OV
Z, C, AC, OV
C
1
1
1
1Note
1Note
1Note
1
1
1
1Note
1
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
1
1Note
1
1Note
Z
Z
Z
Z
Arithmetic
ADD A,[m]
ADDM A,[m]
ADD A,x
ADC A,[m]
ADCM A,[m]
SUB A,x
SUB A,[m]
SUBM A,[m]
SBC A,[m]
SBCM A,[m]
DAA [m]
Add Data Memory to ACC
Add ACC to Data Memory
Add immediate data to ACC
Add Data Memory to ACC with Carry
Add ACC to Data memory with Carry
Subtract immediate data from the ACC
Subtract Data Memory from ACC
Subtract Data Memory from ACC with result in Data Memory
Subtract Data Memory from ACC with Carry
Subtract Data Memory from ACC with Carry, result in Data Memory
Decimal adjust ACC for Addition with result in Data Memory
Logic Operation
AND A,[m]
OR A,[m]
XOR A,[m]
ANDM A,[m]
ORM A,[m]
XORM A,[m]
AND A,x
OR A,x
XOR A,x
CPL [m]
CPLA [m]
Logical AND Data Memory to ACC
Logical OR Data Memory to ACC
Logical XOR Data Memory to ACC
Logical AND ACC to Data Memory
Logical OR ACC to Data Memory
Logical XOR ACC to Data Memory
Logical AND immediate Data to ACC
Logical OR immediate Data to ACC
Logical XOR immediate Data to ACC
Complement Data Memory
Complement Data Memory with result in ACC
Increment & Decrement
INCA [m]
INC [m]
DECA [m]
DEC [m]
Rev. 1.00
Increment Data Memory with result in ACC
Increment Data Memory
Decrement Data Memory with result in ACC
Decrement Data Memory
97
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
Mnemonic
Description
Cycles
Flag Affected
Rotate Data Memory right with result in ACC
Rotate Data Memory right
Rotate Data Memory right through Carry with result in ACC
Rotate Data Memory right through Carry
Rotate Data Memory left with result in ACC
Rotate Data Memory left
Rotate Data Memory left through Carry with result in ACC
Rotate Data Memory left through Carry
1
1Note
1
1Note
1
1Note
1
1Note
None
None
C
C
None
None
C
C
Move Data Memory to ACC
Move ACC to Data Memory
Move immediate data to ACC
1
1Note
1
None
None
None
Clear bit of Data Memory
Set bit of Data Memory
1Note
1Note
None
None
Jump unconditionally
Skip if Data Memory is zero
Skip if Data Memory is zero with data movement to ACC
Skip if bit i of Data Memory is zero
Skip if bit i of Data Memory is not zero
Skip if increment Data Memory is zero
Skip if decrement Data Memory is zero
Skip if increment Data Memory is zero with result in ACC
Skip if decrement Data Memory is zero with result in ACC
Subroutine call
Return from subroutine
Return from subroutine and load immediate data to ACC
Return from interrupt
2
1Note
1note
1Note
1Note
1Note
1Note
1Note
1Note
2
2
2
2
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
Read table (current page) to TBLH and Data Memory
Read table (last page) to TBLH and Data Memory
2Note
2Note
None
None
No operation
Clear Data Memory
Set Data Memory
Clear Watchdog Timer
Pre-clear Watchdog Timer
Pre-clear Watchdog Timer
Swap nibbles of Data Memory
Swap nibbles of Data Memory with result in ACC
Enter power down mode
1
1Note
1Note
1
1
1
1Note
1
1
None
None
None
TO, PDF
TO, PDF
TO, PDF
None
None
TO, PDF
Rotate
RRA [m]
RR [m]
RRCA [m]
RRC [m]
RLA [m]
RL [m]
RLCA [m]
RLC [m]
Data Move
MOV A,[m]
MOV [m],A
MOV A,x
Bit Operation
CLR [m].i
SET [m].i
Branch
JMP addr
SZ [m]
SZA [m]
SZ [m].i
SNZ [m].i
SIZ [m]
SDZ [m]
SIZA [m]
SDZA [m]
CALL addr
RET
RET A,x
RETI
Table Read
TABRDC [m]
TABRDL [m]
Miscellaneous
NOP
CLR [m]
SET [m]
CLR WDT
CLR WDT1
CLR WDT2
SWAP [m]
SWAPA [m]
HALT
Note:
1. For skip instructions, if the result of the comparison involves a skip then two cycles are required,
if no skip takes place only one cycle is required.
2. Any instruction which changes the contents of the PCL will also require 2 cycles for execution.
3. For the ²CLR WDT1² and ²CLR WDT2² instructions the TO and PDF flags may be affected by
the execution status. The TO and PDF flags are cleared after both ²CLR WDT1² and
²CLR WDT2² instructions are consecutively executed. Otherwise the TO and PDF flags
remain unchanged.
Rev. 1.00
98
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
Instruction Definition
ADC A,[m]
Add Data Memory to ACC with Carry
Description
The contents of the specified Data Memory, Accumulator and the carry flag are added. The
result is stored in the Accumulator.
Operation
ACC ¬ ACC + [m] + C
Affected flag(s)
OV, Z, AC, C
ADCM A,[m]
Add ACC to Data Memory with Carry
Description
The contents of the specified Data Memory, Accumulator and the carry flag are added. The
result is stored in the specified Data Memory.
Operation
[m] ¬ ACC + [m] + C
Affected flag(s)
OV, Z, AC, C
ADD A,[m]
Add Data Memory to ACC
Description
The contents of the specified Data Memory and the Accumulator are added. The result is
stored in the Accumulator.
Operation
ACC ¬ ACC + [m]
Affected flag(s)
OV, Z, AC, C
ADD A,x
Add immediate data to ACC
Description
The contents of the Accumulator and the specified immediate data are added. The result is
stored in the Accumulator.
Operation
ACC ¬ ACC + x
Affected flag(s)
OV, Z, AC, C
ADDM A,[m]
Add ACC to Data Memory
Description
The contents of the specified Data Memory and the Accumulator are added. The result is
stored in the specified Data Memory.
Operation
[m] ¬ ACC + [m]
Affected flag(s)
OV, Z, AC, C
AND A,[m]
Logical AND Data Memory to ACC
Description
Data in the Accumulator and the specified Data Memory perform a bitwise logical AND operation. The result is stored in the Accumulator.
Operation
ACC ¬ ACC ²AND² [m]
Affected flag(s)
Z
AND A,x
Logical AND immediate data to ACC
Description
Data in the Accumulator and the specified immediate data perform a bitwise logical AND
operation. The result is stored in the Accumulator.
Operation
ACC ¬ ACC ²AND² x
Affected flag(s)
Z
ANDM A,[m]
Logical AND ACC to Data Memory
Description
Data in the specified Data Memory and the Accumulator perform a bitwise logical AND operation. The result is stored in the Data Memory.
Operation
[m] ¬ ACC ²AND² [m]
Affected flag(s)
Z
Rev. 1.00
99
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
CALL addr
Subroutine call
Description
Unconditionally calls a subroutine at the specified address. The Program Counter then increments by 1 to obtain the address of the next instruction which is then pushed onto the
stack. The specified address is then loaded and the program continues execution from this
new address. As this instruction requires an additional operation, it is a two cycle instruction.
Operation
Stack ¬ Program Counter + 1
Program Counter ¬ addr
Affected flag(s)
None
CLR [m]
Clear Data Memory
Description
Each bit of the specified Data Memory is cleared to 0.
Operation
[m] ¬ 00H
Affected flag(s)
None
CLR [m].i
Clear bit of Data Memory
Description
Bit i of the specified Data Memory is cleared to 0.
Operation
[m].i ¬ 0
Affected flag(s)
None
CLR WDT
Clear Watchdog Timer
Description
The TO, PDF flags and the WDT are all cleared.
Operation
WDT cleared
TO ¬ 0
PDF ¬ 0
Affected flag(s)
TO, PDF
CLR WDT1
Pre-clear Watchdog Timer
Description
The TO, PDF flags and the WDT are all cleared. Note that this instruction works in conjunction with CLR WDT2 and must be executed alternately with CLR WDT2 to have effect. Repetitively executing this instruction without alternately executing CLR WDT2 will have no
effect.
Operation
WDT cleared
TO ¬ 0
PDF ¬ 0
Affected flag(s)
TO, PDF
CLR WDT2
Pre-clear Watchdog Timer
Description
The TO, PDF flags and the WDT are all cleared. Note that this instruction works in conjunction with CLR WDT1 and must be executed alternately with CLR WDT1 to have effect. Repetitively executing this instruction without alternately executing CLR WDT1 will have no
effect.
Operation
WDT cleared
TO ¬ 0
PDF ¬ 0
Affected flag(s)
TO, PDF
Rev. 1.00
100
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
CPL [m]
Complement Data Memory
Description
Each bit of the specified Data Memory is logically complemented (1¢s complement). Bits
which previously contained a 1 are changed to 0 and vice versa.
Operation
[m] ¬ [m]
Affected flag(s)
Z
CPLA [m]
Complement Data Memory with result in ACC
Description
Each bit of the specified Data Memory is logically complemented (1¢s complement). Bits
which previously contained a 1 are changed to 0 and vice versa. The complemented result
is stored in the Accumulator and the contents of the Data Memory remain unchanged.
Operation
ACC ¬ [m]
Affected flag(s)
Z
DAA [m]
Decimal-Adjust ACC for addition with result in Data Memory
Description
Convert the contents of the Accumulator value to a BCD ( Binary Coded Decimal) value resulting from the previous addition of two BCD variables. If the low nibble is greater than 9 or
if AC flag is set, then a value of 6 will be added to the low nibble. Otherwise the low nibble
remains unchanged. If the high nibble is greater than 9 or if the C flag is set, then a value of
6 will be added to the high nibble. Essentially, the decimal conversion is performed by adding 00H, 06H, 60H or 66H depending on the Accumulator and flag conditions. Only the C
flag may be affected by this instruction which indicates that if the original BCD sum is
greater than 100, it allows multiple precision decimal addition.
Operation
[m] ¬ ACC + 00H or
[m] ¬ ACC + 06H or
[m] ¬ ACC + 60H or
[m] ¬ ACC + 66H
Affected flag(s)
C
DEC [m]
Decrement Data Memory
Description
Data in the specified Data Memory is decremented by 1.
Operation
[m] ¬ [m] - 1
Affected flag(s)
Z
DECA [m]
Decrement Data Memory with result in ACC
Description
Data in the specified Data Memory is decremented by 1. The result is stored in the Accumulator. The contents of the Data Memory remain unchanged.
Operation
ACC ¬ [m] - 1
Affected flag(s)
Z
HALT
Enter power down mode
Description
This instruction stops the program execution and turns off the system clock. The contents
of the Data Memory and registers are retained. The WDT and prescaler are cleared. The
power down flag PDF is set and the WDT time-out flag TO is cleared.
Operation
TO ¬ 0
PDF ¬ 1
Affected flag(s)
TO, PDF
Rev. 1.00
101
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
INC [m]
Increment Data Memory
Description
Data in the specified Data Memory is incremented by 1.
Operation
[m] ¬ [m] + 1
Affected flag(s)
Z
INCA [m]
Increment Data Memory with result in ACC
Description
Data in the specified Data Memory is incremented by 1. The result is stored in the Accumulator. The contents of the Data Memory remain unchanged.
Operation
ACC ¬ [m] + 1
Affected flag(s)
Z
JMP addr
Jump unconditionally
Description
The contents of the Program Counter are replaced with the specified address. Program
execution then continues from this new address. As this requires the insertion of a dummy
instruction while the new address is loaded, it is a two cycle instruction.
Operation
Program Counter ¬ addr
Affected flag(s)
None
MOV A,[m]
Move Data Memory to ACC
Description
The contents of the specified Data Memory are copied to the Accumulator.
Operation
ACC ¬ [m]
Affected flag(s)
None
MOV A,x
Move immediate data to ACC
Description
The immediate data specified is loaded into the Accumulator.
Operation
ACC ¬ x
Affected flag(s)
None
MOV [m],A
Move ACC to Data Memory
Description
The contents of the Accumulator are copied to the specified Data Memory.
Operation
[m] ¬ ACC
Affected flag(s)
None
NOP
No operation
Description
No operation is performed. Execution continues with the next instruction.
Operation
No operation
Affected flag(s)
None
OR A,[m]
Logical OR Data Memory to ACC
Description
Data in the Accumulator and the specified Data Memory perform a bitwise logical OR operation. The result is stored in the Accumulator.
Operation
ACC ¬ ACC ²OR² [m]
Affected flag(s)
Z
Rev. 1.00
102
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
OR A,x
Logical OR immediate data to ACC
Description
Data in the Accumulator and the specified immediate data perform a bitwise logical OR operation. The result is stored in the Accumulator.
Operation
ACC ¬ ACC ²OR² x
Affected flag(s)
Z
ORM A,[m]
Logical OR ACC to Data Memory
Description
Data in the specified Data Memory and the Accumulator perform a bitwise logical OR operation. The result is stored in the Data Memory.
Operation
[m] ¬ ACC ²OR² [m]
Affected flag(s)
Z
RET
Return from subroutine
Description
The Program Counter is restored from the stack. Program execution continues at the restored address.
Operation
Program Counter ¬ Stack
Affected flag(s)
None
RET A,x
Return from subroutine and load immediate data to ACC
Description
The Program Counter is restored from the stack and the Accumulator loaded with the
specified immediate data. Program execution continues at the restored address.
Operation
Program Counter ¬ Stack
ACC ¬ x
Affected flag(s)
None
RETI
Return from interrupt
Description
The Program Counter is restored from the stack and the interrupts are re-enabled by setting the EMI bit. EMI is the master interrupt global enable bit. If an interrupt was pending
when the RETI instruction is executed, the pending Interrupt routine will be processed before returning to the main program.
Operation
Program Counter ¬ Stack
EMI ¬ 1
Affected flag(s)
None
RL [m]
Rotate Data Memory left
Description
The contents of the specified Data Memory are rotated left by 1 bit with bit 7 rotated into bit
0.
Operation
[m].(i+1) ¬ [m].i; (i = 0~6)
[m].0 ¬ [m].7
Affected flag(s)
None
RLA [m]
Rotate Data Memory left with result in ACC
Description
The contents of the specified Data Memory are rotated left by 1 bit with bit 7 rotated into bit
0. The rotated result is stored in the Accumulator and the contents of the Data Memory remain unchanged.
Operation
ACC.(i+1) ¬ [m].i; (i = 0~6)
ACC.0 ¬ [m].7
Affected flag(s)
None
Rev. 1.00
103
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
RLC [m]
Rotate Data Memory left through Carry
Description
The contents of the specified Data Memory and the carry flag are rotated left by 1 bit. Bit 7
replaces the Carry bit and the original carry flag is rotated into bit 0.
Operation
[m].(i+1) ¬ [m].i; (i = 0~6)
[m].0 ¬ C
C ¬ [m].7
Affected flag(s)
C
RLCA [m]
Rotate Data Memory left through Carry with result in ACC
Description
Data in the specified Data Memory and the carry flag are rotated left by 1 bit. Bit 7 replaces
the Carry bit and the original carry flag is rotated into the bit 0. The rotated result is stored in
the Accumulator and the contents of the Data Memory remain unchanged.
Operation
ACC.(i+1) ¬ [m].i; (i = 0~6)
ACC.0 ¬ C
C ¬ [m].7
Affected flag(s)
C
RR [m]
Rotate Data Memory right
Description
The contents of the specified Data Memory are rotated right by 1 bit with bit 0 rotated into
bit 7.
Operation
[m].i ¬ [m].(i+1); (i = 0~6)
[m].7 ¬ [m].0
Affected flag(s)
None
RRA [m]
Rotate Data Memory right with result in ACC
Description
Data in the specified Data Memory and the carry flag are rotated right by 1 bit with bit 0 rotated into bit 7. The rotated result is stored in the Accumulator and the contents of the Data
Memory remain unchanged.
Operation
ACC.i ¬ [m].(i+1); (i = 0~6)
ACC.7 ¬ [m].0
Affected flag(s)
None
RRC [m]
Rotate Data Memory right through Carry
Description
The contents of the specified Data Memory and the carry flag are rotated right by 1 bit. Bit 0
replaces the Carry bit and the original carry flag is rotated into bit 7.
Operation
[m].i ¬ [m].(i+1); (i = 0~6)
[m].7 ¬ C
C ¬ [m].0
Affected flag(s)
C
RRCA [m]
Rotate Data Memory right through Carry with result in ACC
Description
Data in the specified Data Memory and the carry flag are rotated right by 1 bit. Bit 0 replaces the Carry bit and the original carry flag is rotated into bit 7. The rotated result is
stored in the Accumulator and the contents of the Data Memory remain unchanged.
Operation
ACC.i ¬ [m].(i+1); (i = 0~6)
ACC.7 ¬ C
C ¬ [m].0
Affected flag(s)
C
Rev. 1.00
104
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
SBC A,[m]
Subtract Data Memory from ACC with Carry
Description
The contents of the specified Data Memory and the complement of the carry flag are subtracted from the Accumulator. The result is stored in the Accumulator. Note that if the result
of subtraction is negative, the C flag will be cleared to 0, otherwise if the result is positive or
zero, the C flag will be set to 1.
Operation
ACC ¬ ACC - [m] - C
Affected flag(s)
OV, Z, AC, C
SBCM A,[m]
Subtract Data Memory from ACC with Carry and result in Data Memory
Description
The contents of the specified Data Memory and the complement of the carry flag are subtracted from the Accumulator. The result is stored in the Data Memory. Note that if the result of subtraction is negative, the C flag will be cleared to 0, otherwise if the result is
positive or zero, the C flag will be set to 1.
Operation
[m] ¬ ACC - [m] - C
Affected flag(s)
OV, Z, AC, C
SDZ [m]
Skip if decrement Data Memory is 0
Description
The contents of the specified Data Memory are first decremented by 1. If the result is 0 the
following instruction is skipped. As this requires the insertion of a dummy instruction while
the next instruction is fetched, it is a two cycle instruction. If the result is not 0 the program
proceeds with the following instruction.
Operation
[m] ¬ [m] - 1
Skip if [m] = 0
Affected flag(s)
None
SDZA [m]
Skip if decrement Data Memory is zero with result in ACC
Description
The contents of the specified Data Memory are first decremented by 1. If the result is 0, the
following instruction is skipped. The result is stored in the Accumulator but the specified
Data Memory contents remain unchanged. As this requires the insertion of a dummy instruction while the next instruction is fetched, it is a two cycle instruction. If the result is not
0, the program proceeds with the following instruction.
Operation
ACC ¬ [m] - 1
Skip if ACC = 0
Affected flag(s)
None
SET [m]
Set Data Memory
Description
Each bit of the specified Data Memory is set to 1.
Operation
[m] ¬ FFH
Affected flag(s)
None
SET [m].i
Set bit of Data Memory
Description
Bit i of the specified Data Memory is set to 1.
Operation
[m].i ¬ 1
Affected flag(s)
None
Rev. 1.00
105
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
SIZ [m]
Skip if increment Data Memory is 0
Description
The contents of the specified Data Memory are first incremented by 1. If the result is 0, the
following instruction is skipped. As this requires the insertion of a dummy instruction while
the next instruction is fetched, it is a two cycle instruction. If the result is not 0 the program
proceeds with the following instruction.
Operation
[m] ¬ [m] + 1
Skip if [m] = 0
Affected flag(s)
None
SIZA [m]
Skip if increment Data Memory is zero with result in ACC
Description
The contents of the specified Data Memory are first incremented by 1. If the result is 0, the
following instruction is skipped. The result is stored in the Accumulator but the specified
Data Memory contents remain unchanged. As this requires the insertion of a dummy instruction while the next instruction is fetched, it is a two cycle instruction. If the result is not
0 the program proceeds with the following instruction.
Operation
ACC ¬ [m] + 1
Skip if ACC = 0
Affected flag(s)
None
SNZ [m].i
Skip if bit i of Data Memory is not 0
Description
If bit i of the specified Data Memory is not 0, the following instruction is skipped. As this requires the insertion of a dummy instruction while the next instruction is fetched, it is a two
cycle instruction. If the result is 0 the program proceeds with the following instruction.
Operation
Skip if [m].i ¹ 0
Affected flag(s)
None
SUB A,[m]
Subtract Data Memory from ACC
Description
The specified Data Memory is subtracted from the contents of the Accumulator. The result
is stored in the Accumulator. Note that if the result of subtraction is negative, the C flag will
be cleared to 0, otherwise if the result is positive or zero, the C flag will be set to 1.
Operation
ACC ¬ ACC - [m]
Affected flag(s)
OV, Z, AC, C
SUBM A,[m]
Subtract Data Memory from ACC with result in Data Memory
Description
The specified Data Memory is subtracted from the contents of the Accumulator. The result
is stored in the Data Memory. Note that if the result of subtraction is negative, the C flag will
be cleared to 0, otherwise if the result is positive or zero, the C flag will be set to 1.
Operation
[m] ¬ ACC - [m]
Affected flag(s)
OV, Z, AC, C
SUB A,x
Subtract immediate data from ACC
Description
The immediate data specified by the code is subtracted from the contents of the Accumulator. The result is stored in the Accumulator. Note that if the result of subtraction is negative, the C flag will be cleared to 0, otherwise if the result is positive or zero, the C flag will
be set to 1.
Operation
ACC ¬ ACC - x
Affected flag(s)
OV, Z, AC, C
Rev. 1.00
106
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
SWAP [m]
Swap nibbles of Data Memory
Description
The low-order and high-order nibbles of the specified Data Memory are interchanged.
Operation
[m].3~[m].0 « [m].7 ~ [m].4
Affected flag(s)
None
SWAPA [m]
Swap nibbles of Data Memory with result in ACC
Description
The low-order and high-order nibbles of the specified Data Memory are interchanged. The
result is stored in the Accumulator. The contents of the Data Memory remain unchanged.
Operation
ACC.3 ~ ACC.0 ¬ [m].7 ~ [m].4
ACC.7 ~ ACC.4 ¬ [m].3 ~ [m].0
Affected flag(s)
None
SZ [m]
Skip if Data Memory is 0
Description
If the contents of the specified Data Memory is 0, the following instruction is skipped. As
this requires the insertion of a dummy instruction while the next instruction is fetched, it is a
two cycle instruction. If the result is not 0 the program proceeds with the following instruction.
Operation
Skip if [m] = 0
Affected flag(s)
None
SZA [m]
Skip if Data Memory is 0 with data movement to ACC
Description
The contents of the specified Data Memory are copied to the Accumulator. If the value is
zero, the following instruction is skipped. As this requires the insertion of a dummy instruction while the next instruction is fetched, it is a two cycle instruction. If the result is not 0 the
program proceeds with the following instruction.
Operation
ACC ¬ [m]
Skip if [m] = 0
Affected flag(s)
None
SZ [m].i
Skip if bit i of Data Memory is 0
Description
If bit i of the specified Data Memory is 0, the following instruction is skipped. As this requires the insertion of a dummy instruction while the next instruction is fetched, it is a two
cycle instruction. If the result is not 0, the program proceeds with the following instruction.
Operation
Skip if [m].i = 0
Affected flag(s)
None
TABRDC [m]
Read table (current page) to TBLH and Data Memory
Description
The low byte of the program code (current page) addressed by the table pointer (TBLP) is
moved to the specified Data Memory and the high byte moved to TBLH.
Operation
[m] ¬ program code (low byte)
TBLH ¬ program code (high byte)
Affected flag(s)
None
TABRDL [m]
Read table (last page) to TBLH and Data Memory
Description
The low byte of the program code (last page) addressed by the table pointer (TBLP) is
moved to the specified Data Memory and the high byte moved to TBLH.
Operation
[m] ¬ program code (low byte)
TBLH ¬ program code (high byte)
Affected flag(s)
None
Rev. 1.00
107
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
XOR A,[m]
Logical XOR Data Memory to ACC
Description
Data in the Accumulator and the specified Data Memory perform a bitwise logical XOR operation. The result is stored in the Accumulator.
Operation
ACC ¬ ACC ²XOR² [m]
Affected flag(s)
Z
XORM A,[m]
Logical XOR ACC to Data Memory
Description
Data in the specified Data Memory and the Accumulator perform a bitwise logical XOR operation. The result is stored in the Data Memory.
Operation
[m] ¬ ACC ²XOR² [m]
Affected flag(s)
Z
XOR A,x
Logical XOR immediate data to ACC
Description
Data in the Accumulator and the specified immediate data perform a bitwise logical XOR
operation. The result is stored in the Accumulator.
Operation
ACC ¬ ACC ²XOR² x
Affected flag(s)
Z
Rev. 1.00
108
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
Package Information
16-pin DIP (300mil) Outline Dimensions
A
B
A
1 6
9
1
8
B
1 6
9
1
8
H
H
C
C
D
D
G
E
G
E
I
F
I
F
Fig1. Full Lead Packages
Fig2. 1/2 Lead Packages
· MS-001d (see fig1)
Symbol
A
Dimensions in mil
Min.
Nom.
Max.
780
¾
880
B
240
¾
280
C
115
¾
195
D
115
¾
150
E
14
¾
22
F
45
¾
70
G
¾
100
¾
H
300
¾
325
I
¾
¾
430
· MS-001d (see fig2)
Symbol
A
Rev. 1.00
Dimensions in mil
Min.
Nom.
Max.
735
¾
775
B
240
¾
280
C
115
¾
195
D
115
¾
150
E
14
¾
22
70
F
45
¾
G
¾
100
¾
H
300
¾
325
I
¾
¾
430
109
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
· MO-095a (see fig2)
Symbol
A
Rev. 1.00
Dimensions in mil
Min.
Nom.
Max.
745
¾
785
B
275
¾
295
C
120
¾
150
D
110
¾
150
E
14
¾
22
F
45
¾
60
G
¾
100
¾
H
300
¾
325
I
¾
¾
430
110
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
16-pin NSOP (150mil) Outline Dimensions
1 6
A
9
B
8
1
C
C '
G
H
D
E
Symbol
Rev. 1.00
a
F
Dimensions in mil
Min.
Nom.
Max.
A
228
¾
244
B
149
¾
157
C
14
¾
20
C¢
386
¾
394
D
53
¾
69
E
¾
50
¾
F
4
¾
10
G
22
¾
28
H
4
¾
12
a
0°
¾
10°
111
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
16-pin SSOP (150mil) Outline Dimensions
9
1 6
A
B
1
8
C
C '
G
H
D
E
Symbol
Dimensions in inch
Min.
Nom.
Max.
0.228
¾
0.244
B
0.150
¾
0.157
C
0.008
¾
0.012
C¢
0.189
¾
0.197
D
0.054
¾
0.060
E
¾
0.025
¾
F
0.004
¾
0.010
G
0.022
¾
0.028
H
0.007
¾
0.010
a
0°
¾
8°
A
Symbol
A
Rev. 1.00
a
F
Dimensions in mm
Min.
Nom.
Max.
5.79
¾
6.20
B
3.81
¾
3.99
C
0.20
¾
0.30
C¢
4.80
¾
5.00
D
1.37
¾
1.52
E
¾
0.64
¾
F
0.10
¾
0.25
G
0.56
¾
0.71
H
0.18
¾
0.25
a
0°
¾
8°
112
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
20-pin DIP (300mil) Outline Dimensions
A
B
A
2 0
1 1
1
1 0
B
2 0
1 1
1 0
1
H
H
C
C
D
D
E
F
I
G
E
F
Fig1. Full Lead Packages
I
G
Fig2. 1/2 Lead Packages
· MS-001d (see fig1)
Symbol
Dimensions in mil
Min.
Nom.
Max.
A
980
¾
1060
B
240
¾
280
C
115
¾
195
D
115
¾
150
E
14
¾
22
F
45
¾
70
G
¾
100
¾
H
300
¾
325
I
¾
¾
430
· MO-095a (see fig2)
Symbol
Rev. 1.00
Dimensions in mil
Min.
Nom.
Max.
A
945
¾
985
B
275
¾
295
C
120
¾
150
D
110
¾
150
E
14
¾
22
F
45
¾
60
G
¾
100
¾
H
300
¾
325
I
¾
¾
430
113
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
20-pin SOP (300mil) Outline Dimensions
1 1
2 0
A
B
1
1 0
C
C '
G
H
D
E
a
F
· MS-013
Symbol
Rev. 1.00
Dimensions in mil
Min.
Nom.
Max.
A
393
¾
419
B
256
¾
300
C
12
¾
20
C¢
496
¾
512
D
¾
¾
104
E
¾
50
¾
F
4
¾
12
G
16
¾
50
H
8
¾
13
a
0°
¾
8°
114
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
20-pin SSOP (150mil) Outline Dimensions
1 1
2 0
A
B
1
1 0
C
C '
G
H
D
E
Symbol
Dimensions in inch
Min.
Nom.
Max.
0.228
¾
0.244
B
0.150
¾
0.158
C
0.008
¾
0.012
C¢
0.335
¾
0.347
D
0.049
¾
0.065
E
¾
0.025
¾
F
0.004
¾
0.010
G
0.015
¾
0.050
H
0.007
¾
0.010
a
0°
¾
8°
A
Symbol
A
Rev. 1.00
a
F
Dimensions in mm
Min.
Nom.
Max.
5.79
¾
6.20
B
3.81
¾
4.01
C
0.20
¾
0.30
C¢
8.51
¾
8.81
D
1.24
¾
1.65
E
¾
0.64
¾
F
0.10
¾
0.25
G
0.38
¾
1.27
H
0.18
¾
0.25
a
0°
¾
8°
115
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
24-pin SKDIP (300mil) Outline Dimensions
A
A
1 3
2 4
B
1 3
2 4
B
1 2
1
1 2
1
H
H
C
C
D
D
E
F
I
G
E
F
I
G
Fig2. 1/2 Lead Packages
Fig1. Full Lead Packages
· MS-001d (see fig1)
Symbol
Dimensions in mil
Min.
Nom.
Max.
A
1230
¾
1280
B
240
¾
280
C
115
¾
195
D
115
¾
150
E
14
¾
22
F
45
¾
70
G
¾
100
¾
H
300
¾
325
I
¾
¾
430
· MS-001d (see fig2)
Symbol
Rev. 1.00
Dimensions in mil
Min.
Nom.
Max.
A
1160
¾
1195
B
240
¾
280
C
115
¾
195
D
115
¾
150
E
14
¾
22
F
45
¾
70
G
¾
100
¾
H
300
¾
325
I
¾
¾
430
116
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
· MO-095a (see fig2)
Symbol
A
Rev. 1.00
Dimensions in mil
Min.
Nom.
Max.
1145
¾
1185
B
275
¾
295
C
120
¾
150
D
110
¾
150
E
14
¾
22
F
45
¾
60
G
¾
100
¾
H
300
¾
325
I
¾
¾
430
117
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
24-pin SOP (300mil) Outline Dimensions
1 3
2 4
A
B
1 2
1
C
C '
G
H
D
E
a
F
· MS-013
Symbol
Rev. 1.00
Dimensions in mil
Min.
Nom.
Max.
A
393
¾
419
B
256
¾
300
C
12
¾
20
C¢
598
¾
613
D
¾
¾
104
E
¾
50
¾
F
4
¾
12
G
16
¾
50
H
8
¾
13
a
0°
¾
8°
118
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
24-pin SSOP (150mil) Outline Dimensions
1 3
2 4
A
B
1 2
1
C
C '
G
H
D
E
Symbol
Dimensions in inch
Min.
Nom.
Max.
0.228
¾
0.244
B
0.150
¾
0.157
C
0.008
¾
0.012
C¢
0.335
¾
0.346
D
0.054
¾
0.060
E
¾
0.025
¾
F
0.004
¾
0.010
G
0.022
¾
0.028
H
0.007
¾
0.010
a
0°
¾
8°
A
Symbol
A
Rev. 1.00
a
F
Dimensions in mm
Min.
Nom.
Max.
5.79
¾
6.20
B
3.81
¾
3.99
C
0.20
¾
0.30
C¢
8.51
¾
8.79
D
1.37
¾
1.52
E
¾
0.64
¾
F
0.10
¾
0.25
G
0.56
¾
0.71
H
0.18
¾
0.25
a
0°
¾
8°
119
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
28-pin SKDIP (300mil) Outline Dimensions
A
B
2 8
1 5
1
1 4
H
C
D
E
Symbol
A
Rev. 1.00
F
I
G
Dimensions in mil
Min.
Nom.
Max.
1375
¾
1395
B
278
¾
298
C
125
¾
135
D
125
¾
145
E
16
¾
20
F
50
¾
70
G
¾
100
¾
H
295
¾
315
I
¾
¾
375
120
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
28-pin SOP (300mil) Outline Dimensions
2 8
1 5
A
B
1
1 4
C
C '
G
H
D
E
a
F
· MS-013
Symbol
Rev. 1.00
Dimensions in mil
Min.
Nom.
Max.
A
393
¾
419
B
256
¾
300
C
12
¾
20
C¢
697
¾
713
D
¾
¾
104
E
¾
50
¾
F
4
¾
12
G
16
¾
50
H
8
¾
13
a
0°
¾
8°
121
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
28-pin SSOP (150mil) Outline Dimensions
1 5
2 8
A
B
1 4
1
C
C '
G
H
D
E
Symbol
Dimensions in inch
Min.
Nom.
Max.
0.228
¾
0.244
B
0.150
¾
0.157
C
0.008
¾
0.012
C¢
0.386
¾
0.394
D
0.054
¾
0.060
E
¾
0.025
¾
F
0.004
¾
0.010
G
0.022
¾
0.028
H
0.007
¾
0.010
a
0°
¾
8°
A
Symbol
A
Rev. 1.00
a
F
Dimensions in mm
Min.
Nom.
Max.
5.79
¾
6.20
B
3.81
¾
3.99
C
0.20
¾
0.30
C¢
9.80
¾
10.01
D
1.37
¾
1.52
E
¾
0.64
¾
F
0.10
¾
0.25
G
0.56
¾
0.71
H
0.18
¾
0.25
a
0°
¾
8°
122
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
28-pin SSOP (209mil) Outline Dimensions
1 5
2 8
A
B
1 4
1
C
C '
G
H
D
E
a
F
· MO-150
Symbol
Rev. 1.00
Dimensions in mm
Min.
Nom.
Max.
A
7.40
¾
8.20
B
5.00
¾
5.60
C
0.22
¾
0.33
C¢
9.90
¾
10.50
D
¾
E
¾
0.65
F
0.05
¾
¾
G
0.55
¾
0.95
H
0.09
¾
0.21
a
0°
¾
8°
2.00
123
¾
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
44-pin QFP (10mm´10mm) Outline Dimensions
H
C
D
G
2 3
3 3
I
3 4
2 2
L
F
A
B
E
1 2
4 4
K
a
J
1
Symbol
A
Rev. 1.00
1 1
Dimensions in mm
Min.
Nom.
Max.
13.00
¾
13.40
B
9.90
¾
10.10
C
13.00
¾
13.40
D
9.90
¾
10.10
E
¾
0.80
¾
F
¾
0.30
¾
G
1.90
¾
2.20
H
¾
¾
2.70
I
0.25
¾
0.50
J
0.73
¾
0.93
K
0.10
¾
0.20
L
¾
0.10
¾
a
0°
¾
7°
124
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
52-pin QFP (14mm´14mm) Outline Dimensions
C
H
D
3 9
G
2 7
I
2 6
4 0
F
A
B
E
1 4
5 2
K
J
1
Symbol
A
Rev. 1.00
1 3
Dimensions in mm
Min.
Nom.
Max.
17.30
¾
17.50
B
13.90
¾
14.10
C
17.30
¾
17.50
D
13.90
¾
14.10
E
¾
1.00
¾
F
¾
0.40
¾
G
2.50
¾
3.10
H
¾
¾
3.40
I
¾
0.10
¾
J
0.73
¾
1.03
K
0.10
¾
0.20
a
0°
¾
7°
125
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
Product Tape and Reel Specifications
Reel Dimensions
D
T 2
A
C
B
T 1
SOP 16N (150mil), SSOP 20S (150mil), SSOP 24S (150mil), SSOP 28S (150mil)
Symbol
Description
A
Reel Outer Diameter
B
Reel Inner Diameter
C
Spindle Hole Diameter
D
Key Slit Width
T1
Space Between Flange
T2
Reel Thickness
Dimensions in mm
330.0±1.0
100.0±1.5
13.0
+0.5/-0.2
2.0±0.5
16.8
+0.3/-0.2
22.2±0.2
SSOP 16S
Symbol
Description
A
Reel Outer Diameter
B
Reel Inner Diameter
C
Spindle Hole Diameter
D
Key Slit Width
T1
Space Between Flange
T2
Reel Thickness
Dimensions in mm
330.0±1.0
100.0±1.5
13.0
+0.5/-0.2
2.0±0.5
12.8
+0.3/-0.2
18.2±0.2
SOP 20W, SOP 24W, SOP 28W (300mil)
Symbol
Description
A
Reel Outer Diameter
B
Reel Inner Diameter
C
Spindle Hole Diameter
D
Key Slit Width
T1
Space Between Flange
T2
Reel Thickness
Rev. 1.00
Dimensions in mm
330.0±1.0
100.0±1.5
13.0
+0.5/-0.2
2.0±0.5
24.8
+0.3/-0.2
30.2±0.2
126
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
SSOP 28S (209mil)
Symbol
Description
A
Reel Outer Diameter
Dimensions in mm
330.0±1.0
B
Reel Inner Diameter
C
Spindle Hole Diameter
D
Key Slit Width
T1
Space Between Flange
28.4
T2
Reel Thickness
31.1 (max.)
100.0±1.5
13.0
+0.5/-0.2
2.0±0.5
+0.3/-0.2
Carrier Tape Dimensions
P 0
D
P 1
t
E
F
W
B 0
C
D 1
P
K 0
A 0
R e e l H o le
IC p a c k a g e p in 1 a n d th e r e e l h o le s
a r e lo c a te d o n th e s a m e s id e .
SOP 16N (150mil)
Symbol
Description
Dimensions in mm
W
Carrier Tape Width
P
Cavity Pitch
8.0±0.1
E
Perforation Position
1.75±0.1
F
Cavity to Perforation (Width Direction)
D
Perforation Diameter
1.55
+0.10/-0.00
D1
Cavity Hole Diameter
1.50
+0.25/-0.00
P0
Perforation Pitch
4.0±0.1
P1
Cavity to Perforation (Length Direction)
2.0±0.1
A0
Cavity Length
6.5±0.1
B0
Cavity Width
10.3±0.1
K0
Cavity Depth
16.0±0.3
7.5±0.1
2.1±0.1
t
Carrier Tape Thickness
0.30±0.05
C
Cover Tape Width
13.3±0.1
Rev. 1.00
127
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
SOP 20W
Symbol
Description
Dimensions in mm
24.0
+0.3/-0.1
W
Carrier Tape Width
P
Cavity Pitch
12.0±0.1
E
Perforation Position
1.75±0.10
F
Cavity to Perforation (Width Direction)
11.5±0.1
D
Perforation Diameter
1.5
1.50
+0.1/-0.0
+0.25/-0.00
D1
Cavity Hole Diameter
P0
Perforation Pitch
4.0±0.1
P1
Cavity to Perforation (Length Direction)
2.0±0.1
A0
Cavity Length
10.8±0.1
B0
Cavity Width
13.3±0.1
K0
Cavity Depth
3.2±0.1
t
Carrier Tape Thickness
0.30±0.05
C
Cover Tape Width
21.3±0.1
SSOP 16S
Symbol
Description
Dimensions in mm
12.0
+0.3/-0.1
W
Carrier Tape Width
P
Cavity Pitch
E
Perforation Position
F
Cavity to Perforation (Width Direction)
D
Perforation Diameter
D1
Cavity Hole Diameter
P0
Perforation Pitch
4.0±0.1
P1
Cavity to Perforation (Length Direction)
2.0±0.1
A0
Cavity Length
6.4±0.1
B0
Cavity Width
5.2±0.1
K0
Cavity Depth
2.1±0.1
t
Carrier Tape Thickness
C
Cover Tape Width
Rev. 1.00
8.0±0.1
1.75±0.10
5.5±0.1
1.55±0.10
1.50
+0.25/-0.00
0.30±0.05
9.3±0.1
128
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
SSOP 20S (150mil)
Symbol
Description
W
Carrier Tape Width
P
Cavity Pitch
E
Perforation Position
F
Cavity to Perforation (Width Direction)
D
Perforation Diameter
Dimensions in mm
16.0
+0.3/-0.1
8.0±0.1
1.75±0.10
7.5±0.1
1.5
1.50
+0.1/-0.0
+0.25/-0.00
D1
Cavity Hole Diameter
P0
Perforation Pitch
4.0±0.1
P1
Cavity to Perforation (Length Direction)
2.0±0.1
A0
Cavity Length
6.5±0.1
B0
Cavity Width
9.0±0.1
K0
Cavity Depth
2.3±0.1
t
Carrier Tape Thickness
0.30±0.05
C
Cover Tape Width
13.3±0.1
SSOP 24S (150mil)
Symbol
Description
Dimensions in mm
16.0
+0.3/-0.1
W
Carrier Tape Width
P
Cavity Pitch
E
Perforation Position
F
Cavity to Perforation (Width Direction)
D
Perforation Diameter
1.5
D1
Cavity Hole Diameter
1.50
P0
Perforation Pitch
4.0±0.1
P1
Cavity to Perforation (Length Direction)
2.0±0.1
A0
Cavity Length
6.5±0.1
B0
Cavity Width
9.5±0.1
K0
Cavity Depth
2.1±0.1
8.0±0.1
1.75±0.10
7.5±0.1
+0.1/-0.0
+0.25/-0.00
t
Carrier Tape Thickness
0.30±0.05
C
Cover Tape Width
13.3±0.1
Rev. 1.00
129
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
SSOP 28S (150mil)
Symbol
Description
Dimensions in mm
W
Carrier Tape Width
16.0±0.3
P
Cavity Pitch
8.0±0.1
E
Perforation Position
1.75±0.1
F
Cavity to Perforation (Width Direction)
D
Perforation Diameter
1.55
+0.10/-0.00
D1
Cavity Hole Diameter
1.50
+0.25/-0.00
P0
Perforation Pitch
4.0±0.1
P1
Cavity to Perforation (Length Direction)
2.0±0.1
A0
Cavity Length
6.5±0.1
B0
Cavity Width
10.3±0.1
K0
Cavity Depth
2.1±0.1
7.5±0.1
t
Carrier Tape Thickness
0.30±0.05
C
Cover Tape Width
13.3±0.1
SSOP 28S (209mil)
Symbol
Description
Dimensions in mm
W
Carrier Tape Width
24.0±0.3
P
Cavity Pitch
12.0±0.1
E
Perforation Position
1.75±0.10
F
Cavity to Perforation (Width Direction)
11.5±0.1
D
Perforation Diameter
1.5
D1
Cavity Hole Diameter
1.50
P0
Perforation Pitch
4.0±0.2
P1
Cavity to Perforation (Length Direction)
2.0±0.1
A0
Cavity Length
8.4±0.1
B0
Cavity Width
10.65±0.10
K0
Cavity Depth
2.4±0.1
+0.1/-0.0
+0.25/-0.00
t
Carrier Tape Thickness
0.30±0.05
C
Cover Tape Width
21.3±0.1
Rev. 1.00
130
March 11, 2010
HT56R22/HT56R23/HT56R24/HT56R25/HT56R26
Holtek Semiconductor Inc. (Headquarters)
No.3, Creation Rd. II, Science Park, Hsinchu, Taiwan
Tel: 886-3-563-1999
Fax: 886-3-563-1189
http://www.holtek.com.tw
Holtek Semiconductor Inc. (Taipei Sales Office)
4F-2, No. 3-2, YuanQu St., Nankang Software Park, Taipei 115, Taiwan
Tel: 886-2-2655-7070
Fax: 886-2-2655-7373
Fax: 886-2-2655-7383 (International sales hotline)
Holtek Semiconductor Inc. (Shenzhen Sales Office)
5F, Unit A, Productivity Building, No.5 Gaoxin M 2nd Road, Nanshan District, Shenzhen, China 518057
Tel: 86-755-8616-9908, 86-755-8616-9308
Fax: 86-755-8616-9722
Holtek Semiconductor (USA), Inc. (North America Sales Office)
46729 Fremont Blvd., Fremont, CA 94538, USA
Tel: 1-510-252-9880
Fax: 1-510-252-9885
http://www.holtek.com
Copyright Ó 2010 by HOLTEK SEMICONDUCTOR INC.
The information appearing in this Data Sheet is believed to be accurate at the time of publication. However, Holtek assumes no responsibility arising from the use of the specifications described. The applications mentioned herein are used
solely for the purpose of illustration and Holtek makes no warranty or representation that such applications will be suitable
without further modification, nor recommends the use of its products for application that may present a risk to human life
due to malfunction or otherwise. Holtek¢s products are not authorized for use as critical components in life support devices
or systems. Holtek reserves the right to alter its products without prior notification. For the most up-to-date information,
please visit our web site at http://www.holtek.com.tw.
Rev. 1.00
131
March 11, 2010